blob: 0e69b206c2d77d9fe3238e89ec13d726c7e0e83d [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaue54b43a2019-11-25 19:47:40 +01007 2019/11/25
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
574. Proxies
584.1. Proxy keywords matrix
594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
60
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100615. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200625.1. Bind options
635.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200645.3. Server DNS resolution
655.3.1. Global overview
665.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020067
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100686. Cache
696.1. Limitation
706.2. Setup
716.2.1. Cache section
726.2.2. Proxy section
73
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200747. Using ACLs and fetching samples
757.1. ACL basics
767.1.1. Matching booleans
777.1.2. Matching integers
787.1.3. Matching strings
797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
807.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
817.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
827.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
837.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200847.3.1. Converters
857.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
867.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
877.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
887.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
897.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100907.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200917.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092
938. Logging
948.1. Log levels
958.2. Log formats
968.2.1. Default log format
978.2.2. TCP log format
988.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100998.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001008.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001018.3. Advanced logging options
1028.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1038.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1048.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1058.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1068.4. Timing events
1078.5. Session state at disconnection
1088.6. Non-printable characters
1098.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1108.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1118.9. Examples of logs
112
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001139. Supported filters
1149.1. Trace
1159.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001169.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001179.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001189.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200119
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012010. FastCGI applications
12110.1. Setup
12210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12310.1.2. Proxy section
12410.1.3. Example
12510.2. Default parameters
12610.3. Limitations
127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128
1291. Quick reminder about HTTP
130----------------------------
131
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100132When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
134on almost anything found in the contents.
135
136However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
137formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
138correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
139
140
1411.1. The HTTP transaction model
142-------------------------------
143
144The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100145to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100146from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
147connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148will involve a new connection :
149
150 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
151
152In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
153establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
154by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
155length.
156
157Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
158to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
159however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
160response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
161header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
162
163 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
164
165Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
166power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
167but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200168a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100170Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
172second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
173page :
174
175 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
176
177This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
178latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
179correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
180the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100181server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100183The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
184time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
185are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
186parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
187carry the stream identifier.
188
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
190connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
191leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
193processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
194waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200195
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200196HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
198 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100199 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200201 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100202
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100203For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
204the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100205server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
206is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
207servers.
208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209
2101.2. HTTP request
211-----------------
212
213First, let's consider this HTTP request :
214
215 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100216 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
218 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
219 3 User-agent: my small browser
220 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
221 5 Accept: image/png
222
223
2241.2.1. The Request line
225-----------------------
226
227Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
228
229 - a METHOD : GET
230 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
231 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
232
233All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
234which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
235followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
236is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
237desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
238the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
239
240The URI itself can have several forms :
241
242 - A "relative URI" :
243
244 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
245
246 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
247 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
248
249 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
250
251 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
252
253 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
254 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
255 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
256 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
257 must accept this form too.
258
259 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
260 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
261 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200263 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
264 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
265 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
266 other protocols too.
267
268In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
269mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
270on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
271It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
272specific to the language, framework or application in use.
273
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100275assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
277received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
278processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
279as well as in server logs.
280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
297as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200298
299The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
300that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
301is one valid form of empty line.
302
303Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
304headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
305about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
306application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
307
308Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000309 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200310 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
311 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
312 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
313
314
3151.3. HTTP response
316------------------
317
318An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
319messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
320
321 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
324 2 Content-length: 350
325 3 Content-Type: text/html
326
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200327As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
328codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
329response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100330continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
331the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
332following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
333sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
334(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
335correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
336such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
337state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
338over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
339if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
340information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200342
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003431.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344------------------------
345
346Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
347
348 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
349 - a status code : 200
350 - a reason : OK
351
352The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100353 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
354 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
355 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
356 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
357 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200358
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000359Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100360"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
362messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
363or "Authentication Required".
364
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100365HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200366
367 Code When / reason
368 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
369 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
370 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100372 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 400 for an invalid or too large request
375 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
376 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200377 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100378 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200379 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100380 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
381 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
383 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
384 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200385 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
387 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
388 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
389
390The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3914.2).
392
393
3941.3.2. The response headers
395---------------------------
396
397Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
398the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
399details.
400
401
4022. Configuring HAProxy
403----------------------
404
4052.1. Configuration file format
406------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200407
408HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
409
410 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
411 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
412 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
413 "frontend" and "backend".
414
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100415The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
416referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200417delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200419
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004202.2. Quoting and escaping
421-------------------------
422
423HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
424many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
425with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
426single quotes.
427
428If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
429them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
430escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
431
432Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
433
434 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
435 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
436 \\ to use a backslash
437 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
438 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
439
440Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
441the interpretation of:
442
443 space as a parameter separator
444 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
445 # hash as a comment start
446
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200447Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
448-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
449backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
450
451Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200452quoting.
453
454Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
455nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
456
457Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
458equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
459
460 Example:
461 # those are equivalents:
462 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
463 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
464 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
465 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
467
468 # those are equivalents:
469 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
470 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
473
474
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004752.3. Environment variables
476--------------------------
477
478HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
479interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
480configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
481optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
482shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
483underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
484
485 Example:
486
487 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
488
489 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
490
491 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
492
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
494file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200495
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
497 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
498
499* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
500 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
501 directory.
502
503* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
504
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500505* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200506 processes, separated by semicolons.
507
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500508* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200509 CLI, separated by semicolons.
510
511See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200512
5132.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200514----------------
515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100516Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100517values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
518otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
519numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
520for every keyword. Supported units are :
521
522 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
523 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
524 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
525 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
526 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
527 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
528
529
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005302.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200531-------------
532
533 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
534 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
535 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
536 global
537 daemon
538 maxconn 256
539
540 defaults
541 mode http
542 timeout connect 5000ms
543 timeout client 50000ms
544 timeout server 50000ms
545
546 frontend http-in
547 bind *:80
548 default_backend servers
549
550 backend servers
551 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
552
553
554 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
555 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
556 global
557 daemon
558 maxconn 256
559
560 defaults
561 mode http
562 timeout connect 5000ms
563 timeout client 50000ms
564 timeout server 50000ms
565
566 listen http-in
567 bind *:80
568 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
569
570
571Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
572
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100573 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200574
575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005763. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577--------------------
578
579Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
580are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
581of them have command-line equivalents.
582
583The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
584
585 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200586 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200588 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200590 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - description
592 - deviceatlas-json-file
593 - deviceatlas-log-level
594 - deviceatlas-separator
595 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900596 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - gid
598 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100599 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200600 - h1-case-adjust
601 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100602 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100603 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200604 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200605 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100606 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200607 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200608 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200609 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200610 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200611 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100613 - presetenv
614 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200615 - uid
616 - ulimit-n
617 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200618 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100619 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200620 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200621 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200622 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-options
624 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200625 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-server-options
627 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100628 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100629 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100630 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100631 - 51degrees-data-file
632 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200633 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200634 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200635 - wurfl-data-file
636 - wurfl-information-list
637 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200638 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100639 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100640
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200641 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100642 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200643 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200644 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200645 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100646 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100647 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100648 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200649 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200650 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200651 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200652 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200653 - noepoll
654 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000655 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200656 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100657 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300658 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000659 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100660 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200661 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200662 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200663 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000664 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000665 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200666 - tune.buffers.limit
667 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200668 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200669 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100670 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200671 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200672 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200673 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100674 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200675 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200676 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100677 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100678 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100679 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100680 - tune.lua.session-timeout
681 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200682 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100683 - tune.maxaccept
684 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200685 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200686 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200687 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100688 - tune.rcvbuf.client
689 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100690 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200691 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100692 - tune.sndbuf.client
693 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100694 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100695 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200696 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100697 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200698 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200699 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100700 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200701 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100702 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200703 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
704 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
705 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100706 - tune.zlib.memlevel
707 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100708
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200709 * Debugging
710 - debug
711 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200712
713
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007143.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200715------------------------------------
716
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200717ca-base <dir>
718 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200719 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
720 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200721
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200722chroot <jail dir>
723 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
724 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
725 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
726 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
727 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100728 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100729
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
731 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
732 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
733 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
734 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
735 set. These sets have the format
736
737 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
738
739 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100740 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100741 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
742 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100743 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
744 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100745 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100746 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100747 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100748 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100749 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
750 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
751 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
752 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100753
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100754 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
755 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
756 on the machine's word size.
757
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100758 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100759 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
760 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
761 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
762 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
763 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
764 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100765
766 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100767 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
768
769 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
770 # first 4 CPUs
771
772 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
773 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
774 # word size.
775
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100776 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100777 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100778 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
779 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
780 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
781
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100782 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
783 # and so on.
784 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
785 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
786 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
787
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100788 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100789 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
790 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
791 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
792
793 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
794 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
795 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
796
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100797 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
798 # and a thread range.
799 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
800 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
801 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
802
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200803crt-base <dir>
804 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100805 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
806 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200807
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200808daemon
809 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
810 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100811 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
812 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200813
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200814deviceatlas-json-file <path>
815 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100816 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200817
818deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100819 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200820 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
821
822deviceatlas-separator <char>
823 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
824 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
825
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100826deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200827 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
828 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
829 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100830
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900831external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100832 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
833 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100834 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
835 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
836 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
837 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
838 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900839
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200840gid <number>
841 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
842 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
843 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100844 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
845 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200846 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100847
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100848group <group name>
849 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
850 See also "gid" and "user".
851
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100852hard-stop-after <time>
853 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
854
855 Arguments :
856 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
857 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
858 SIGUSR1 signal.
859
860 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
861 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
862 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
863
864 Example:
865 global
866 hard-stop-after 30s
867
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200868h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
869 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
870 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
871 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
872 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
873 ajusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
874 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
875 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
876 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
877 specified in a proxy.
878
879 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
880 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
881 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
882 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
883 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
884 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
885 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
886
887 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
888 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
889 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
890 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
891 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
892
893 Example:
894 global
895 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
896
897 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
898 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
899
900h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
901 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
902 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
903 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
904 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
905 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
906 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
907 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
908 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
909
910 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
911 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
912 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
913
914 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
915 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
916
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100917insecure-fork-wanted
918 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
919 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
920 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
921 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
922 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
923 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
924 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
925 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
926 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
927 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
928 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
929 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
930 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
931 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
932 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
933 disable it.
934
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100935insecure-setuid-wanted
936 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
937 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
938 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
939 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
940 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
941 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
942 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
943 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
944 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
945 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
946 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
947 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
948 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
949 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
950
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200951log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
952 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100953 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100954 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100955 configured with "log global".
956
957 <address> can be one of:
958
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100959 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100960 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
961 port).
962
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100963 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
964 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
965 port).
966
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100967 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100968 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
969 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100970 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100971
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100972 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
973 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
974 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
975 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
976 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
977 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
978 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
979 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
980 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
981 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
982 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
983 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
984 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
985 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100986 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
987 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100988
989 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
990 "fd@2", see above.
991
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +0200992 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
993 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
994 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
995 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
996 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
997
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200998 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
999 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001000
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001001 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1002 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1003 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1004 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1005 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1006 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1007 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1008 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1009 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1010 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001011 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1012 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001013
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001014 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1015 one of the following :
1016
1017 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1018 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1019
1020 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1021 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1022
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001023 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1024 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1025 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1026 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1027 logger consumes.
1028
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001029 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1030 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1031 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1032 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1033
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001034 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1035 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1036 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1037 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1038 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1039
1040 <sample_size>
1041 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1042 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1043 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1044 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1045 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1046
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001047 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001048
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001049 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1050 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1051 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1052
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001053 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1054 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1055 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1056 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001057
1058 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001059 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1060 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1061 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1062 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1063 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1064 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001065
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001066 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001067
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001068log-send-hostname [<string>]
1069 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1070 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1071 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1072 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1073 the logs.
1074
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001075log-tag <string>
1076 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1077 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1078 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001079 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001080
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001081lua-load <file>
1082 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1083 used multiple times.
1084
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001085master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001086 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1087 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1088 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001089 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001090 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1091 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001092 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1093 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1094 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1095 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1096 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001097
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001098 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001099
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001100mworker-max-reloads <number>
1101 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001102 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001103 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1104 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1105 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1106
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001107nbproc <number>
1108 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1109 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1110 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001111 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1112 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001113 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1114 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001115
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001116nbthread <number>
1117 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001118 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1119 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1120 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1121 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1122 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001123 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1124 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1125 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1126 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1127 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1128 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1129 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001130
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001131pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001132 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001133 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1134 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1135
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001136presetenv <name> <value>
1137 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1138 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1139 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1140 and "unsetenv".
1141
1142resetenv [<name> ...]
1143 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1144 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1145 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1146 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1147 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1148 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1149 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1150 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1151
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001152stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001153 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1154 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1155 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1156 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1157 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1158 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001159 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001160 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1161 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1162 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1163 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001164
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001165server-state-base <directory>
1166 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001167 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1168 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001169
1170server-state-file <file>
1171 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1172 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1173 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1174 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1175 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1176 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1177 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1178 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001179 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1180 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001181
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001182setenv <name> <value>
1183 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1184 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1185 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1186 and "unsetenv".
1187
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001188set-dumpable
1189 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001190 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1191 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1192 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1193 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1194 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1195 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1196 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1197 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1198 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1199 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1200 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1201 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1202 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1203 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1204 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1205 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1206 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001207
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001208ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1209 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1210 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001211 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001212 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001213 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1214 information and recommendations see e.g.
1215 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1216 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1217 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1218 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001219
1220ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1221 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1222 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1223 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1224 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1225 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001226 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1227 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1228 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001229 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001230
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001231ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1232 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1233 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1234 keyword to see available options.
1235
1236 Example:
1237 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001238 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001239
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001240ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1241 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1242 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001243 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001244 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001245 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1246 information and recommendations see e.g.
1247 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1248 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1249 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1250 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1251 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001252
1253ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1254 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1255 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1256 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1257 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1258 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001259 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1260 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1261 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1262 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001263
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001264ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1265 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1266 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1267 keyword to see available options.
1268
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001269ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1270 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1271 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1272 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001273 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001274 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001275 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1276 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1277 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1278 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001279 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1280 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1281 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1282
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001283ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1284 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1285 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1286 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1287
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001288stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1289 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1290 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1291 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001292 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001293 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001294
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001295 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1296 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1297 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001298
1299stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1300 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1301 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001302 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001303
1304stats maxconn <connections>
1305 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1306 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1307
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001308uid <number>
1309 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1310 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1311 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1312 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1313
1314ulimit-n <number>
1315 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1316 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1317 option.
1318
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001319unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1320 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1321
1322 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1323 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1324 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1325 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1326 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1327 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1328 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1329 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1330 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1331 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1332
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001333unsetenv [<name> ...]
1334 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1335 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1336 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1337 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1338 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1339 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1340 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1341
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001342user <user name>
1343 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1344 See also "uid" and "group".
1345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001346node <name>
1347 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1348
1349 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1350 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1351 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1352 traffic.
1353
1354description <text>
1355 Add a text that describes the instance.
1356
1357 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1358 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1359 "<" and ">" characters.
1360
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100136151degrees-data-file <file path>
1362 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001363 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001364
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001365 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001366 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1367
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000136851degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001369 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1370 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1371 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1372
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001373 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001374 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1375
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200137651degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001377 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1378 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1379
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001380 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1381 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1382
138351degrees-cache-size <number>
1384 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1385 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1386 By default, this cache is disabled.
1387
1388 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001389 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1390
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001391wurfl-data-file <file path>
1392 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1393 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1394
1395 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1396 with USE_WURFL=1.
1397
1398wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1399 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1400 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1401 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1402
1403 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1404
1405 Valid WURFL properties are:
1406 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1407
1408 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1409 device.
1410
1411 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1412 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1413
1414 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1415 particular web request.
1416
1417 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1418 used Libwurfl API version.
1419
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001420 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1421 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1422
1423 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1424 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1425
1426 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1427
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001428 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1429 with USE_WURFL=1.
1430
1431wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1432 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1433 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1434
1435 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1436 with USE_WURFL=1.
1437
1438wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1439 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1440 thus before the chroot.
1441
1442 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1443 with USE_WURFL=1.
1444
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001445wurfl-cache-size <size>
1446 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1447 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001448 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001449 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001450
1451 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1452 with USE_WURFL=1.
1453
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001454strict-limits
1455 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1456 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1457 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1458 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1459 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1460 keyword.
1461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014623.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001463-----------------------
1464
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001465busy-polling
1466 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1467 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1468 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1469 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1470 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1471 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1472 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1473 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1474 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1475 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1476 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1477 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1478 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1479 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1480 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1481 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1482 "poll" pollers.
1483
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001484 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1485 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1486 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1487
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001488max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1489 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1490 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1491 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1492 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1493 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1494 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1495 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1496 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1497
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001498maxconn <number>
1499 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1500 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1501 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001502 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1503 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1504 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1505 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001506 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1507 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1508 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1509 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1510 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1511 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001512
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001513maxconnrate <number>
1514 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1515 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1516 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1517 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1518 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1519 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1520 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1521 fairness.
1522
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001523maxcomprate <number>
1524 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001525 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001526 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1527 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1528 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001529 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001530 default value.
1531
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001532maxcompcpuusage <number>
1533 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1534 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1535 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1536 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1537 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1538 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1539 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1540 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1541
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001542maxpipes <number>
1543 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1544 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1545 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1546 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1547 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1548 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1549
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001550maxsessrate <number>
1551 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1552 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1553 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1554 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1555 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1556 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1557 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1558 fairness.
1559
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001560maxsslconn <number>
1561 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1562 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1563 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1564 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1565 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1566 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1567 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001568 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1569 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1570 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1571 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1572 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1573 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1574 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001575
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001576maxsslrate <number>
1577 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1578 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1579 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1580 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1581 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1582 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1583 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1584 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1585 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1586 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1587
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001588maxzlibmem <number>
1589 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1590 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1591 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001592 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1593 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1594 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1595
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001596noepoll
1597 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1598 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001599 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001600
1601nokqueue
1602 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1603 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1604 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1605
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001606noevports
1607 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1608 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1609 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1610 also "nopoll".
1611
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001612nopoll
1613 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1614 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001615 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001616 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1617 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001618
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001619nosplice
1620 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001621 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001622 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001623 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001624 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1625 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1626 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1627 "option splice-response".
1628
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001629nogetaddrinfo
1630 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1631 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1632
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001633noreuseport
1634 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1635 command line argument "-dR".
1636
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001637profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1638 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1639 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1640 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1641 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001642 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001643 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1644 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1645 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1646 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1647
1648 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1649 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1650 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1651 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1652 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001653 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1654 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1655 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1656 CLI.
1657
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001658spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001659 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1660 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1661 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1662 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1663 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1664 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001665
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001666ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001667 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001668 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001669 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1670 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1671 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1672 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1673 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001674 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1675 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001676 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1677 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1678 openssl configuration file uses:
1679 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1680
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001681ssl-mode-async
1682 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001683 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001684 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1685 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1686 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001687 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001688 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001689
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001690tune.buffers.limit <number>
1691 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1692 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1693 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1694 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1695 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001696 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001697 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1698 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1699 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1700 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1701 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1702 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1703 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1704 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1705 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1706
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001707tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1708 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1709 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1710 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1711 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1712
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001713tune.bufsize <number>
1714 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1715 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1716 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1717 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1718 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1719 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1720 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001721 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1722 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1723 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001724 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001725 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1726 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1727 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001728
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001729tune.chksize <number>
1730 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1731 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1732 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1733 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1734 checks whenever possible.
1735
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001736tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1737 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1738 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1739 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1740 this value. The default value is 1.
1741
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001742tune.fail-alloc
1743 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1744 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1745 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1746 gracefully.
1747
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001748tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1749 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1750 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1751 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1752 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1753 change it.
1754
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001755tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1756 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001757 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1758 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001759 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1760 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1761 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1762 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1763 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1764
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001765tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1766 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1767 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1768 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1769 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1770 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1771 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1772 recommended not to change this value.
1773
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001774tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1775 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1776 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1777 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1778 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1779 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1780 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1781 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1782
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001783tune.http.cookielen <number>
1784 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1785 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1786 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1787 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1788 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1789 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1790 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1791 to change this value.
1792
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001793tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001794 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1795 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001796 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001797 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001798 configuration directives too.
1799 The default value is 1024.
1800
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001801tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1802 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1803 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1804 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1805 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1806 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1807 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001808 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1809 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1810 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001811
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001812tune.idletimer <timeout>
1813 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1814 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1815 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1816 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1817 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1818 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001819 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001820 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001821 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1822
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001823tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1824 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1825 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1826 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1827 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1828 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1829 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1830 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1831 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1832 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1833
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001834tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1835 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001836 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001837 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1838 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001839 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001840 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1841 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1842
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001843tune.lua.maxmem
1844 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1845 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1846 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1847 memory.
1848
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001849tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1850 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001851 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1852 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001853 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001854
1855tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1856 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1857 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1858 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1859 check servers.
1860
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001861tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1862 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1863 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1864 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001865 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001866
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001867tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001868 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1869 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1870 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1871 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1872 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1873 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1874 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1875 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1876 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1877 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001878
1879tune.maxpollevents <number>
1880 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1881 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1882 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1883 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1884 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1885
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001886tune.maxrewrite <number>
1887 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1888 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1889 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1890 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1891 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1892 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1893 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1894 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1895 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1896 bufsize.
1897
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001898tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1899 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1900 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1901 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1902 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1903 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1904 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1905 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1906 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1907 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001908 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1909 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001910 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1911 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1912 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1913 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1914 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1915 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1916 setting this parameter to 0.
1917
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001918tune.pipesize <number>
1919 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1920 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1921 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1922 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1923 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1924 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1925
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001926tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1927 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1928 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1929 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1930 default is 20.
1931
1932tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1933 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1934 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1935 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1936 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1937 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1938 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001939 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001940
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001941tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1942tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1943 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1944 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1945 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001946 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001947 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001948 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1949 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1950
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001951tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001952 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001953 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1954 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1955 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1956 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1957
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001958tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001959 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001960 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1961 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1962
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001963tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1964tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1965 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1966 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1967 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001968 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001969 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001970 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1971 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1972 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1973 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1974 notifying haproxy again.
1975
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001976tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001977 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1978 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1979 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001980 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001981 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001982 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001983 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1984 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1985 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001986 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1987 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001988
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001989tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001990 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001991 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1992 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1993 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1994 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1995 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1996
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001997tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1998 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001999 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002000 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2001 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2002 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2003 being used for too long.
2004
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002005tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2006 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2007 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2008 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2009 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2010 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2011 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2012 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2013 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2014 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2015 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002016 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002017 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002018
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002019tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2020 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2021 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2022 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2023 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2024 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
2025 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2026 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002027 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2028 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002029
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002030tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2031 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2032 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2033 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2034 1000 entries.
2035
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002036tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2037 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2038 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2039 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2040
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002041tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002042tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002043tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2044tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2045tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002046 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2047 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2048 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2049 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2050 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2051 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2052 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2053 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002054
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002055 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2056 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2057 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2058 all available space is consumed.
2059 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2060 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2061 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002062
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002063tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2064 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002065 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002066 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002067 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002068 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2069
2070tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2071 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2072 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002073 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2074 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002075
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020763.3. Debugging
2077--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002078
2079debug
2080 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2081 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2082 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2083 system startup.
2084
2085quiet
2086 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2087 line argument "-q".
2088
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002089
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020903.4. Userlists
2091--------------
2092It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2093http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2094it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2095
2096userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002097 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002098 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2099
2100group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002101 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002102 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2103 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2104
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002105user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2106 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002107 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2108 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002109 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2110 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2111 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2112 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002113
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002114 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2115 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2116 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2117 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2118 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2119 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2120 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2121 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2122 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002123
2124 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002125 userlist L1
2126 group G1 users tiger,scott
2127 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002128
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002129 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2130 user scott insecure-password elgato
2131 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002132
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002133 userlist L2
2134 group G1
2135 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002136
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002137 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2138 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2139 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002140
2141 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002142
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002143
21443.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002145----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002146It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2147several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2148instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2149values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2150automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2151In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2152using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2153tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2154reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2155Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2156that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2157each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002158
2159peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002160 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002161 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2162
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002163bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2164 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2165 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2166
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002167disabled
2168 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2169 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2170 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2171
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002172default-bind [param*]
2173 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2174
2175default-server [param*]
2176 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2177
2178 Arguments:
2179 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2180 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2181 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2182 details.
2183
2184
2185 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2186
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002187enable
2188 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2189
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002190log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2191 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2192 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2193 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2194 more details.
2195
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002196peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002197 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2198 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2199 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2200 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2201 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2202 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2203
2204 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2205 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2206
2207 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2208 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2209 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2210 across all peers.
2211
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002212 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2213 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002214
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002215 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2216 "server" keyword explanation below).
2217
2218server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002219 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002220 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2221 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2222 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2223 of this "peers" section).
2224 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2225
2226
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002227 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002228 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002229 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002230 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2231 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2232 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002233
2234 backend mybackend
2235 mode tcp
2236 balance roundrobin
2237 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2238 stick on src
2239
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002240 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2241 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002242
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002243 Example:
2244 peers mypeers
2245 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2246 default-server ssl verify none
2247 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2248 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002249
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002250
2251table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2252 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2253
2254 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2255 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002256 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002257 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2258 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2259 "stick-table" keyword).
2260
2261 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2262 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2263 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2264 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2265 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2266 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2267 of the stick-table name as follows:
2268
2269 peers mypeers
2270 peer A ...
2271 peer B ...
2272 table t1 ...
2273
2274 frontend fe1
2275 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2276
2277 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2278 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2279
2280 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2281 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2282 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2283 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2284 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2285 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2286 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2287
2288 peers mypeers
2289 peer A ...
2290 peer B ...
2291 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2292
2293 backend t1
2294 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2295
2296 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2297 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2298 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2299
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090023003.6. Mailers
2301------------
2302It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2303If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2304in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2305
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002306mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002307 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2308 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2309
2310mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2311 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2312
2313 Example:
2314 mailers mymailers
2315 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2316 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2317
2318 backend mybackend
2319 mode tcp
2320 balance roundrobin
2321
2322 email-alert mailers mymailers
2323 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2324 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2325
2326 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2327 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2328
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002329timeout mail <time>
2330 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2331 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2332 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2333 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2334
2335 Example:
2336 mailers mymailers
2337 timeout mail 20s
2338 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002339
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020023403.7. Programs
2341-------------
2342In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2343master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2344managed the same way as the workers.
2345
2346During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2347sequence as a worker:
2348
2349 - the master is re-executed
2350 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2351 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2352 instance of the program
2353
2354During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2355
2356program <name>
2357 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2358 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2359 the management guide).
2360
2361command <command> [arguments*]
2362 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2363 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2364 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2365 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2366
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002367user <user name>
2368 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2369 See also "group".
2370
2371group <group name>
2372 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2373 See also "user".
2374
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002375option start-on-reload
2376no option start-on-reload
2377 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2378 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2379 program section.
2380
2381
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010023823.8. HTTP-errors
2383----------------
2384
2385It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2386imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2387several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2388
2389http-errors <name>
2390 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2391 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2392
2393errorfile <code> <file>
2394 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2395
2396 Arguments :
2397 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2398 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429,
2399 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2400
2401 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2402 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2403 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2404 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2405 before any chroot is performed.
2406
2407 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2408
2409 Example:
2410 http-errors website-1
2411 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2412 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2413 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2414
2415 http-errors website-2
2416 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2417 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2418 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2419
2420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024214. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002422----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002423
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002424Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002425 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002426 - frontend <name>
2427 - backend <name>
2428 - listen <name>
2429
2430A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2431its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2432section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002433section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002434
2435A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2436connections.
2437
2438A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2439to forward incoming connections.
2440
2441A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2442parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2443
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002444All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2445'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2446case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2447
2448Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2449logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2450proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2451However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2452name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2453
2454Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2455and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002456bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002457protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2458modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2459arbitrary criteria.
2460
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002461In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2462a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002463the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002464
2465 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2466 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2467 between responses and new requests.
2468
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002469 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2470 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2471 client-facing connection remains open.
2472
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002473 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2474 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002475
2476The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2477frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2478following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002479weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002480
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002481 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002482
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002483 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2484 ----+-----+-----+----
2485 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2486 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002487 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2488 ----+-----+-----+----
2489 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002490
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002491
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002492
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024934.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2494--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002495
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002496The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2497limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2498they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2499limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002500marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002501option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002502and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2503with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2504specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002505
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002506
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002507 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2508------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2509acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002510backlog X X X -
2511balance X - X X
2512bind - X X -
2513bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002514capture cookie - X X -
2515capture request header - X X -
2516capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002517compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002518cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002519declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002520default-server X - X X
2521default_backend X X X -
2522description - X X X
2523disabled X X X X
2524dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002525email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002526email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002527email-alert mailers X X X X
2528email-alert myhostname X X X X
2529email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002530enabled X X X X
2531errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002532errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002533errorloc X X X X
2534errorloc302 X X X X
2535-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2536errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002537force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002538filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002539fullconn X - X X
2540grace X X X X
2541hash-type X - X X
2542http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002543http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002544http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002545http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002546http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002547http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002548http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002549id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002550ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002551load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002552log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002553log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002554log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002555log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002556max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002557maxconn X X X -
2558mode X X X X
2559monitor fail - X X -
2560monitor-net X X X -
2561monitor-uri X X X -
2562option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2563option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2564option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2565option allbackups (*) X - X X
2566option checkcache (*) X - X X
2567option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2568option contstats (*) X X X -
2569option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2570option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002571-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2572option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002573option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2574option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002575option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002576option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002577option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002578option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002579option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002580option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2581option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2582option httpchk X - X X
2583option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002584option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002585option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002586option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002587option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002588option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002589option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2590option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2591option logasap (*) X X X -
2592option mysql-check X - X X
2593option nolinger (*) X X X X
2594option originalto X X X X
2595option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002596option pgsql-check X - X X
2597option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002598option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002599option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002600option smtpchk X - X X
2601option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2602option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2603option splice-request (*) X X X X
2604option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002605option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002606option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2607option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2608-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002609option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002610option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2611option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2612option tcpka X X X X
2613option tcplog X X X X
2614option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002615external-check command X - X X
2616external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002617persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2618rate-limit sessions X X X -
2619redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002620-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002621retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002622retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002623server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002624server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002625server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002626source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002627stats admin - X X X
2628stats auth X X X X
2629stats enable X X X X
2630stats hide-version X X X X
2631stats http-request - X X X
2632stats realm X X X X
2633stats refresh X X X X
2634stats scope X X X X
2635stats show-desc X X X X
2636stats show-legends X X X X
2637stats show-node X X X X
2638stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002639-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2640stick match - - X X
2641stick on - - X X
2642stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002643stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002644stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002645tcp-check connect - - X X
2646tcp-check expect - - X X
2647tcp-check send - - X X
2648tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002649tcp-request connection - X X -
2650tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002651tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002652tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002653tcp-response content - - X X
2654tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002655timeout check X - X X
2656timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002657timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002658timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002659timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2660timeout http-request X X X X
2661timeout queue X - X X
2662timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002663timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002664timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002665timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002666transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002667unique-id-format X X X -
2668unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002669use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002670use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002671use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002672------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2673 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002674
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026764.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2677---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002678
2679This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2680
2681
2682acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2683 Declare or complete an access list.
2684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2685 no | yes | yes | yes
2686 Example:
2687 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2688 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2689 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2690
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002691 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002692
2693
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002694backlog <conns>
2695 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2697 yes | yes | yes | no
2698 Arguments :
2699 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2700 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002701 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002702
2703 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2704 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2705 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2706 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2707 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2708 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2709 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2710 backlog parameter.
2711
2712 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2713 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2714 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2715
2716 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2717
2718
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002719balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002720balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002721 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2723 yes | no | yes | yes
2724 Arguments :
2725 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2726 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2727 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2728 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2729
2730 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2731 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2732 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2733 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002734 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002735 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002736 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2737 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2738 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2739 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2740 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2741 it, so that you don't worry.
2742
2743 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2744 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2745 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2746 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2747 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2748 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2749 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2750 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002751
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002752 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2753 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2754 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2755 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2756 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2757 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2758 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2759 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2760
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002761 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002762 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002763 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2764 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002765 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002766 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2767 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2768 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2769 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2770 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002771 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2772 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2773 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2774 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2775 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2776 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002777
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002778 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2779 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2780 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2781 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2782 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2783 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2784 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2785 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002786 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002787 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002788 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2789 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2790 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002791
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002792 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2793 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2794 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2795 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2796 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2797 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2798 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2799 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2800 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2801 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2802 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2803 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002804
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002805 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002806 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2807 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2808 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2809 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2810 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2811 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2812 URIs start with a leading "/".
2813
2814 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2815 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2816 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2817 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2818
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002819 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002820 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2821
2822 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002823 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2824 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002825 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2826 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2827 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2828 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002829 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002830 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2831 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002832
2833 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2834 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2835 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2836 server will receive the request.
2837
2838 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2839 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2840 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2841 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2842 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002843 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2844 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2845 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002846
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002847 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2848 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2849 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2850 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2851 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002852
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002853 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002854 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2855 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2856 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2857
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002858 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2859 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2860 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2861
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002862 random
2863 random(<draws>)
2864 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002865 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2866 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2867 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2868 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002869 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2870 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2871 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2872 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2873 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2874 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2875 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2876 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2877 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2878 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2879 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2880 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2881 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2882 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2883 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2884 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2885 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2886 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2887 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2888 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002889
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002890 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002891 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002892 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2893 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2894 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2895 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2896 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2897 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002898 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002899 used instead.
2900
2901 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2902 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2903 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2904 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2905
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002906 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2907 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2908 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2909
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002910 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002911
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002912 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002913 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2914 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002915
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002916 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2917 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2918 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002919
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002920 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002921 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002922 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2923 NTLM relies on.
2924
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002925 Examples :
2926 balance roundrobin
2927 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002928 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002929 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2930 balance hdr(host)
2931 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002932
2933 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2934 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2935
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002936 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002937 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2938 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2939 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02002940 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002941
2942 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2943 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2944 defaults to 16 kB.
2945
2946 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2947 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2948
2949 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2950 Round Robin.
2951
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002952 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002953 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2954 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2955 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2956
2957 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2958
2959 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002960 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002961 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2962 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2963 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002964
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002965 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002966
2967
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002968bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2969bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002970 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2972 no | yes | yes | no
2973 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002974 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2975 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2976 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2977 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002978 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002979 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2980 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2981 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2982 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2983 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2984 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2985 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002986 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2987 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2988 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2989 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2990 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2991 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2992 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002993 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2994 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2995 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002996 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2997 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2998 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2999 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003000 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3001 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3002 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003003
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003004 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3005 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003006 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3007 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3008 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003009 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3010 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3011 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3012 the range.
3013
3014 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3015 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3016 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3017 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3018 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3019 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3020 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003021 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003022 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003023
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003024 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003025 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003026 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3027 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3028 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3029 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3030 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3031 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3032
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003033 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3034 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3035 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3036 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003037
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003038 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3039 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3040 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3041 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3042 in a frontend.
3043
3044 Example :
3045 listen http_proxy
3046 bind :80,:443
3047 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003048 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003049
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003050 listen http_https_proxy
3051 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003052 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003053
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003054 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3055 bind ipv6@:80
3056 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3057 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3058
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003059 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003060 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003061
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003062 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3063 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3064 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3065 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3066 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3067
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003068 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003069 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003070
3071
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003072bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003073 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3075 yes | yes | yes | yes
3076 Arguments :
3077 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3078 may be used to override a default value.
3079
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003080 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003081 option may be combined with other numbers.
3082
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003083 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003084 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3085 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3086 missing from all processes.
3087
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003088 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003089 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003090 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3091 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3092 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3093 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3094 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003095 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003096
3097 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3098 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3099 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3100 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3101 and 'even' instances.
3102
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003103 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3104 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3105 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3106 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003107
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003108 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3109 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3110
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003111 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3112 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3113 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3114
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003115 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3116 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3117
3118 Example :
3119 listen app_ip1
3120 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003121 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003122
3123 listen app_ip2
3124 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003125 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003126
3127 listen management
3128 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003129 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003130
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003131 listen management
3132 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3133 bind-process 1-4
3134
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003135 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003136
3137
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003138capture cookie <name> len <length>
3139 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3141 no | yes | yes | no
3142 Arguments :
3143 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3144 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3145 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3146 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003147 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003148
3149 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3150 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3151 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3152 right if it exceeds <length>.
3153
3154 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3155 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3156 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3157 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3158
3159 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3160 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3161 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3162
3163 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3164 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3165 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003166 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3167 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3168 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003169
3170 Example:
3171 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3172
3173 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003174 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003175
3176
3177capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003178 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3180 no | yes | yes | no
3181 Arguments :
3182 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003183 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003184 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3185 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3186 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3187
3188 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3189 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3190 it exceeds <length>.
3191
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003192 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003193 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3194 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003195 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3196 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3197 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3198 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003199 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003200 environments to find where the request came from.
3201
3202 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3203 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3204 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3205 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003206
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003207 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3208 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3209 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3210 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3211 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003212
3213 Example:
3214 capture request header Host len 15
3215 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003216 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003218 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003219 about logging.
3220
3221
3222capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003223 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3225 no | yes | yes | no
3226 Arguments :
3227 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003228 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003229 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3230 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3231 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3232
3233 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3234 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3235 it exceeds <length>.
3236
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003237 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003238 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3239 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3240 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003241 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3242 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3243 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3244 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003245
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003246 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3247 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3248 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3249 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3250 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003251
3252 Example:
3253 capture response header Content-length len 9
3254 capture response header Location len 15
3255
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003256 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003257 about logging.
3258
3259
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003260compression algo <algorithm> ...
3261compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003262compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003263 Enable HTTP compression.
3264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3265 yes | yes | yes | yes
3266 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003267 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3268 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3269 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3270
3271 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003272 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3273 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3274 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003275
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003276 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003277 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003278
3279 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3280 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3281 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3282 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3283 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003284 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003285
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003286 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3287 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3288 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3289 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3290 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3291 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3292 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003293 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003294
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003295 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003296 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003297 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3298 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3299 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3300 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3301 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003302
3303 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3304 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3305 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3306 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3307 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003308 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3309 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3310 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3311 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3312 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003313 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3314 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003315
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003316 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003317 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3318 "Accept-Encoding" header
3319 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003320 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003321 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3322 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3323 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3324 "multipart"
3325 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3326 header
3327 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3328 and later
3329 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3330 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003331 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003332
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003333 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003334
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003335 Examples :
3336 compression algo gzip
3337 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003338
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003339
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003340cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003341 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3342 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003343 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003344 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3346 yes | no | yes | yes
3347 Arguments :
3348 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3349 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3350 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3351 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3352 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3353 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003354 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003355 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3356 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3357
3358 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3359 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3360 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3361 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3362 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3363 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003364 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3365 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003366 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003367 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3368 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003369
3370 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003371 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003372
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003373 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003374 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003375 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003376 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003377 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3378 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3379 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3380 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3381 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3382 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3383 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003384
3385 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3386 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3387 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3388 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3389 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3390 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3391 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3392 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3393 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003394 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003395 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3396 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3397 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003398
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003399 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3400 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3401 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003402 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3403 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3404 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3405 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003406 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3407 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3408 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003409
3410 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3411 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3412 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3413 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3414 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3415 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3416 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3417 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3418 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3419
3420 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3421 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3422 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3423 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3424 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3425 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3426 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3427 persistence cookie in the cache.
3428 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3429
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003430 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3431 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3432 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3433 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3434 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003435 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003436 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3437 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3438 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3439 they logout.
3440
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003441 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3442 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3443 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3444 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3445
3446 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3447 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3448 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3449 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3450 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3451 this attribute.
3452
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003453 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003454 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003455 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3456 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3457 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3458 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3459 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3460 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003461
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003462 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3463 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3464 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3465 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3466 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3467 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3468 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3469 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003470 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003471 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3472 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3473 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3474 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3475 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3476 the site.
3477
3478 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3479 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3480 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3481 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3482 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3483 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3484 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3485 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3486 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3487 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3488 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3489 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3490 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003491 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003492 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3493 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3494
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003495 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3496 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3497 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3498 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3499 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3500 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3501
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003502 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3503 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3504 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3505 repeated.
3506
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003507 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3508 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3509 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3510 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003511
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003512 Examples :
3513 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3514 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3515 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003516 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003517
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003518 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003519
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003520
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003521declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3522 Declares a capture slot.
3523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3524 no | yes | yes | no
3525 Arguments:
3526 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3527
3528 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3529 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3530 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3531 for use in the response.
3532
3533 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003534 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003535 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3536
3537
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003538default-server [param*]
3539 Change default options for a server in a backend
3540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3541 yes | no | yes | yes
3542 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003543 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3544 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3545 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3546 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003547
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003548 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003549 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3550
3551 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003552
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003553
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003554default_backend <backend>
3555 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3557 yes | yes | yes | no
3558 Arguments :
3559 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3560
3561 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3562 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3563 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3564 will catch all undetermined requests.
3565
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003566 Example :
3567
3568 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3569 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3570 default_backend dynamic
3571
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003572 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003573
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003574
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003575description <string>
3576 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3578 no | yes | yes | yes
3579 Arguments : string
3580
3581 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3582 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3583 it describes.
3584 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3585
3586
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003587disabled
3588 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3590 yes | yes | yes | yes
3591 Arguments : none
3592
3593 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3594 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3595 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3596 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3597 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3598 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3599 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3600
3601 See also : "enabled"
3602
3603
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003604dispatch <address>:<port>
3605 Set a default server address
3606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3607 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003608 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003609
3610 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3611 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3612 during start-up.
3613
3614 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3615 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3616 possible with normal servers.
3617
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003618 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003619 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3620 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3621 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3622 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3623
3624 See also : "server"
3625
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003626
3627dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3628 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3630 yes | no | yes | yes
3631 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3632
3633 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003634 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003635 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3636 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003637 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003638 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003639
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003640enabled
3641 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3643 yes | yes | yes | yes
3644 Arguments : none
3645
3646 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3647 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3648
3649 See also : "disabled"
3650
3651
3652errorfile <code> <file>
3653 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3655 yes | yes | yes | yes
3656 Arguments :
3657 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003658 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3659 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003660
3661 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003662 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003663 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003664 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3665 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003666
3667 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3668 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3669 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3670
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003671 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3672
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003673 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3674 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3675 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3676 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3677
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003678 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3679 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003680 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003681 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3682 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3683 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3684
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003685 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3686 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3687 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003688 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003689 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3690
3691 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3692
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003693 Example :
3694 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003695 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003696 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3697 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3698
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003699
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003700errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3701 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3702 section.
3703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3704 yes | yes | yes | yes
3705 Arguments :
3706 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3707
3708 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
3709 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 403,
3710 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3711
3712 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3713 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3714 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3715 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3716 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3717 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3718 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3719
3720 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" , "errorloc303" and section
3721 3.8 about http-errors.
3722
3723 Example :
3724 errorfiles generic
3725 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3726
3727
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003728errorloc <code> <url>
3729errorloc302 <code> <url>
3730 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3732 yes | yes | yes | yes
3733 Arguments :
3734 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003735 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3736 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003737
3738 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3739 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3740 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3741 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003742 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003743
3744 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3745 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3746 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3747
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003748 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3749
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003750 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3751 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3752 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3753 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003754 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003755 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3756 request.
3757
3758 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3759
3760
3761errorloc303 <code> <url>
3762 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3764 yes | yes | yes | yes
3765 Arguments :
3766 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +01003767 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500,
3768 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003769
3770 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3771 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3772 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3773 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003774 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003775
3776 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3777 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3778 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3779
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003780 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3781
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003782 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3783 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3784 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3785 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003786 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003787
3788 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3789
3790
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003791email-alert from <emailaddr>
3792 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003793 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003794 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3795 yes | yes | yes | yes
3796
3797 Arguments :
3798
3799 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3800
3801 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3802 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3803
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003804 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003805 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3806 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003807
3808
3809email-alert level <level>
3810 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3811 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3812 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3813 yes | yes | yes | yes
3814
3815 Arguments :
3816
3817 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3818 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3819 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3820
3821 By default level is alert
3822
3823 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3824 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3825 for the proxy.
3826
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003827 Alerts are sent when :
3828
3829 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3830 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3831 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3832 is notice or lower
3833 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3834 and a health check status update occurs
3835
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003836 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3837 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003838 section 3.6 about mailers.
3839
3840
3841email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3842 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3843 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3844 yes | yes | yes | yes
3845
3846 Arguments :
3847
3848 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3849
3850 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3851 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3852
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003853 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3854 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003855
3856
3857email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3858 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3859 mailers.
3860 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3861 yes | yes | yes | yes
3862
3863 Arguments :
3864
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003865 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003866
3867 By default the systems hostname is used.
3868
3869 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3870 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3871 for the proxy.
3872
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003873 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3874 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003875
3876
3877email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003878 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003879 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3880 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3881 yes | yes | yes | yes
3882
3883 Arguments :
3884
3885 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3886
3887 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3888 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3889
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003890 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003891 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3892
3893
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003894force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3895 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3896 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003897 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003898
3899 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3900 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3901 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3902 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3903 marked down for maintenance operations.
3904
3905 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3906 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3907 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3908 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3909 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3910 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3911 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3912 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3913 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3914
3915 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3916 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3917 is used.
3918
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003919 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003920 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003921
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003922
3923filter <name> [param*]
3924 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3926 no | yes | yes | yes
3927 Arguments :
3928 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3929 referenced in section 9.
3930
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003931 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003932 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003933 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3934 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003935
3936 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3937 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3938
3939 Example:
3940 listen
3941 bind *:80
3942
3943 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3944 filter compression
3945 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3946
3947 compression algo gzip
3948 compression offload
3949
3950 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3951
3952 See also : section 9.
3953
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003954
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003955fullconn <conns>
3956 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3958 yes | no | yes | yes
3959 Arguments :
3960 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3961 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3962
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003963 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003964 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003965 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003966 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3967 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3968 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3969 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3970 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003971 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003972
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003973 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3974 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003975 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3976 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3977 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003978
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003979 Example :
3980 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3981 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3982 # connections.
3983 backend dynamic
3984 fullconn 10000
3985 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3986 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3987
3988 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3989
3990
3991grace <time>
3992 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003994 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003995 Arguments :
3996 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3997 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3998 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3999
4000 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4001 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004002 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004003 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4004
4005 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4006 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4007 simplify it.
4008
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004009
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004010hash-balance-factor <factor>
4011 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4013 yes | no | no | yes
4014 Arguments :
4015 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4016 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004017 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004018
4019 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4020 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4021 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4022 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4023 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4024 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4025 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4026
4027 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4028 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4029 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4030 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4031 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4032
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004033 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4034 consistent hashing mechanism.
4035
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004036 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4037
4038
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004039hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004040 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4042 yes | no | yes | yes
4043 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004044 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4045 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004046
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004047 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4048 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4049 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4050 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4051 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4052 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4053 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4054 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4055 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4056 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004057
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004058 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4059 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4060 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4061 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4062 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4063 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4064 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4065 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4066 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4067 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4068 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4069 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4070 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004071 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4072 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004073
4074 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4075
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004076 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004077 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4078 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4079 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004080 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4081 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4082 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004083
4084 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4085 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004086 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4087 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4088 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4089 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4090
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004091 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4092 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4093 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4094 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4095 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4096 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4097 parameter.
4098
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004099 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4100 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4101 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4102 used on strings.
4103
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004104 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4105
4106 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4107 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4108 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4109 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4110 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4111 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4112 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4113 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4114 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4115 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4116 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4117 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004118
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004119 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4120 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4121 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004122
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004123 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004124
4125
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004126http-check disable-on-404
4127 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004129 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004130 Arguments : none
4131
4132 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4133 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4134 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4135 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4136 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4137 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4138 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4139 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004140 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4141 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4142 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4143
4144 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4145
4146
4147http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004148 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004150 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004151 Arguments :
4152 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4153 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004154 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004155 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4156 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4157 details on the supported keywords.
4158
4159 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4160 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4161 with the usual backslash ('\').
4162
4163 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4164 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4165 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4166 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4167 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4168
4169 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004170 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004171 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4172 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4173 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4174
4175 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004176 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004177 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4178 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4179 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4180 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4181
4182 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004183 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004184 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4185 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4186 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4187 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4188 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004189 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004190 trace).
4191
4192 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004193 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004194 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4195 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4196 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4197 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4198 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004199 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004200
4201 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4202 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4203 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4204 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4205 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4206 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4207 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4208 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4209
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004210 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4211 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4212 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4213
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004214 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4215 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4216
4217 Examples :
4218 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004219 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004220
4221 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004222 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004223
4224 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004225 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004226
4227 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004228 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004229
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004230 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004231
4232
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004233http-check send-state
4234 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4236 yes | no | yes | yes
4237 Arguments : none
4238
4239 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4240 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4241 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4242 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4243 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4244
4245 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4246 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4247 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4248 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4249 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004250 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4251 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4252 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4253
4254 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4255 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4256 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4257
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004258 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4259 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4260 checked in multiple backends.
4261
4262 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4263 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4264
4265 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4266 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4267 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4268 one fails.
4269
4270 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4271 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4272 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4273
4274 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4275 server's queue.
4276
4277 Example of a header received by the application server :
4278 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4279 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4280
4281 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4282
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004283
4284http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004285 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4286
4287 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4288 no | yes | yes | yes
4289
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004290 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4291 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4292 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4293 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4294 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004295
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004296 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4297 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004298
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004299 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004300
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004301 Example:
4302 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4303 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4304 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004305
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004306 http-request allow if nagios
4307 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4308 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4309 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004310
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004311 Example:
4312 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4313 acl add path /addacl
4314 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004315
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004316 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004317
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004318 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4319 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004320
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004321 Example:
4322 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4323 acl setmap path /setmap
4324 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004325
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004326 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004327
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004328 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4329 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004330
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004331 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4332 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004333
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004334http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004335
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004336 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4337 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4338 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4339 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4340 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4341 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4342 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4343 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004344
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004345http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004346
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004347 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4348 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4349 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4350 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4351 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4352 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4353 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4354 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004355
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004356http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004357
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004358 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4359 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004360
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004361
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004362http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004363
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004364 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4365 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4366 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4367 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4368 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004369
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004370 Example:
4371 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4372 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004373
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004374http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004375
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004376 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004378http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4379 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004380
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004381 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4382 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4383 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4384 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4385 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4386 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4387 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4388 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4389 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004390
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004391 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4392 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4393 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4394 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4395 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4396 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004397
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004398http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004399
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004400 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4401 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4402 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4403 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4404 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4405 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004406
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004407http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004408
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004409 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004410
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004411http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004412
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004413 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4414 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4415 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4416 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4417 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4418 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004419
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004420http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
4421 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004422
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004423 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4424 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4425 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004426 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
4427 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
4428 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
4429 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
4430 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004431 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004432
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004433http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4434 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4435 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4436 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4437
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004438http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4439
4440 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4441 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4442 pointed by <resolvers>.
4443 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4444 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4445 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4446 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4447 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4448 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4449 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4450 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4451 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4452 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4453 to 0.0.0.0.
4454
4455 Example:
4456 resolvers mydns
4457 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4458 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4459 timeout retry 1s
4460 hold valid 10s
4461 hold nx 3s
4462 hold other 3s
4463 hold obsolete 0s
4464 accepted_payload_size 8192
4465
4466 frontend fe
4467 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4468 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4469 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4470
4471 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4472 # which mean DNS resolution error
4473 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4474
4475 default_backend be
4476
4477 backend b_503
4478 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4479 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4480 # 503 error page to end users
4481
4482 backend be
4483 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4484 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4485 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4486 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4487 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4488
4489 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4490 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4491
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004492http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4493
4494 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4495 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4496 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4497 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004498 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4499 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004500
4501 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4502
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004503http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004504
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004505 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4506 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4507 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4508 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4509 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004510
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004511http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004512
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004513 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4514 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4515 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4516 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004517
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004518http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4519 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004520
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004521 This matches the value of all occurences of header field <name> against
4522 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4523 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4524 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4525 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4526 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004527
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004528 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4529 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4530 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4531 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4532 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004533
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004534 Example:
4535 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4536
4537 # applied to:
4538 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4539
4540 # outputs:
4541 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4542
4543 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004544
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004545 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4546
4547 # applied to:
4548 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004549
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004550 # outputs:
4551 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004552
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004553http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4554 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4555
4556 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4557 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
4558 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
4559 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
4560
4561 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4562 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4563 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4564
4565 Example:
4566 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4567 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4568
4569 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4570 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4571
4572 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4573 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4574 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4575 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4576
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004577http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4578 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4579
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004580 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4581 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4582 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4583 against.
4584
4585 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4586 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4587 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004588
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004589 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4590 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4591 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4592 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4593 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4594 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4595 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4596 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4597 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004598 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4599 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004600
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004601 Example:
4602 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4603 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004604
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004605 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4606 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004607
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004608http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4609 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004610
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004611 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4612 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4613 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4614 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004615
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004616 Example:
4617 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004618
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004619 # applied to:
4620 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004621
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004622 # outputs:
4623 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004625http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4626http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004627
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004628 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4629 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4630 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004631
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004632http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
4633 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004634
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01004635 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
4636 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
4637 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
4638 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004639
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004640http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004641
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004642 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4643 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4644 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4645 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4646 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004647
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004648 Arguments:
4649 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4650 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004651
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004652 Example:
4653 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4654 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004655
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004656 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4657 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004658
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004659http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004660
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004661 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4662 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4663 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004664
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004665 Arguments:
4666 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4667 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004668
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004669 Example:
4670 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4671 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004672
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004673 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4674 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4675 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004676
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004677http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004678
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004679 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4680 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4681 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4682 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4683 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004684
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004685 Example:
4686 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4687 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4688 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4689 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4690 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4691 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4692 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4693 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4694 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004695
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004696http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004697
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004698 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4699 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4700 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4701 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4702 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004703
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004704http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4705 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004706
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004707 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4708 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4709 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4710 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4711 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4712 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4713 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4714 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4715 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004716
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004717http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004718
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004719 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4720 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4721 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4722 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4723 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4724 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4725 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004726
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004727http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004728
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004729 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4730 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4731 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004732
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004733http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004734
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004735 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4736 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4737 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4738 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4739 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4740 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4741 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4742 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004743
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004744http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004745
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004746 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4747 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4748 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4749 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4750 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4751 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004752
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004753 Example :
4754 # prepend the host name before the path
4755 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004756
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004757http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004758
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004759 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4760 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4761 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4762 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4763 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004764
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004765http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004766
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004767 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4768 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4769 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4770 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4771 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4772 values have higher priority.
4773 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4774 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4775 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4776 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4777 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004778
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004779http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004780
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004781 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4782 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4783 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4784 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4785 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4786 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4787 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004788
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004789 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004790
4791 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004792 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4793 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004794
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004795http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4796 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4797 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4798 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4799 privacy.
4800
4801 Arguments :
4802 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4803 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004804
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004805 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004806 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4807 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4808
4809 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4810 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4811
4812http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4813
4814 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4815 expression.
4816
4817 Arguments:
4818 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4819 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004820
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004821 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004822 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4823 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4824
4825 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4826 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4827 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4828
4829http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4830
4831 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4832 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4833 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4834 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4835 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4836 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4837 information from the request.
4838
4839 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4840
4841http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4842
4843 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4844 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4845 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4846 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4847 path and the query string.
4848 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4849
4850http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4851
4852 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4853 inline.
4854
4855 Arguments:
4856 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4857 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4858 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4859 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4860 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4861 (request and response)
4862 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4863 processing
4864 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4865 processing
4866 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4867 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4868 and '_'.
4869
4870 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4871 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004872
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004873 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004874 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004875
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004876http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4877 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004878
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004879 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4880 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4881 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4882 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4883 agent name must be used.
4884
4885 Arguments:
4886 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4887
4888 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4889 configuration.
4890
4891http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4892
4893 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4894 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4895 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4896 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4897 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4898 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4899 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4900 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4901 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4902 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4903 action.
4904 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4905 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4906 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4907 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4908 you fully understand how it works.
4909
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01004910http-request strict-mode { on | off }
4911
4912 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4913 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4914 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4915 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4916 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
4917 rewrites optionnal while others must be performed to continue the request
4918 processing.
4919
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01004920 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01004921 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4922 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
4923 rules evaluation.
4924
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004925http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
4926 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004927
4928 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4929 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4930 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4931 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4932 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4933 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4934 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4935 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4936 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4937 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4938 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01004939 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. A specific error
4940 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
4941 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
4942 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
4943 followed by the section name.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004944 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4945
4946http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4947http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4948http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4949
4950 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4951 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4952 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4953 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4954 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4955 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4956 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4957 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4958 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4959 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4960 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4961 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4962
4963 Arguments :
4964 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4965 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4966 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4967 select which table entry to update the counters.
4968
4969 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4970 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4971 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4972 that table until the session ends.
4973
4974 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4975 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4976 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4977 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4978 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4979 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4980 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4981 useful information.
4982
4983 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4984 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4985 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4986 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4987 checks that make use of it.
4988
4989http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4990
4991 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004992
4993 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004994 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004995
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01004996http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4997
4998 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
4999 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5000 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5001 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5002 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5003 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5004
5005 Arguments :
5006 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5007
5008 Example:
5009 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5010
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005011http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005012
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005013 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5014 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5015 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005016
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005017
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005018http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005019 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5020
5021 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5022 no | yes | yes | yes
5023
5024 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5025 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5026 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5027 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5028 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5029 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5030
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005031 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5032 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005033
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005034 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005035
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005036 Example:
5037 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005038
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005039 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005041 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5042 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005043
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005044 Example:
5045 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005046
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005047 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005048
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005049 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5050 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005051
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005052 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5053 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005054
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005055http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005056
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005057 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5058 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5059 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5060 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5061 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5062 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5063 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5064 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005065
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005066http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005067
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005068 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5069 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5070 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5071 example, or to pass some internal information.
5072 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5073 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5074 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005075
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005076http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005077
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005078 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5079 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005080
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005081http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005082
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005083 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005084
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005085http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005086
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005087 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5088 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5089 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5090 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5091 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5092 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5093 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005094
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005095 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5096 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5097 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5098 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5099 keyword.
5100 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
5101 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005102
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005103http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005104
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005105 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5106 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5107 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5108 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5109 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5110 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005111
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005112http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005113
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005114 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005115
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005116http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005117
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005118 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5119 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5120 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5121 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5122 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5123 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005124
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005125http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { errorfile | errorfiles } <err> ]
5126 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005127
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005128 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005129 and emits an HTTP 502 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
5130 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
Christopher Faulet554c0eb2020-01-14 12:00:28 +01005131 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive. A specific error
5132 message may be specified. It may be an error file, using the "errorfile"
5133 keyword followed by the file containing the full HTTP response. It may also
5134 be an error from an http-errors section, using the "errorfiles" keyword
5135 followed by the section name.
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01005136 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005137
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005138http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005139
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005140 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5141 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5142 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5143 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5144 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5145 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005146
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005147http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5148 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005149
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005150 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5151 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005152
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005153 Example:
5154 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005155
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005156 # applied to:
5157 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005158
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005159 # outputs:
5160 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005161
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005162 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005163
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005164http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5165 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005166
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01005167 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005168 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005169
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005170 Example:
5171 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005172
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005173 # applied to:
5174 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005175
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005176 # outputs:
5177 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005178
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005179http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5180http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005181
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005182 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5183 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5184 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005185
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005186http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5187 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005188
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005189 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5190 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5191 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5192 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005193
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005194http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005195
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005196 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5197 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5198 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5199 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5200 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005201
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005202 Arguments:
5203 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005204
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005205 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5206 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005207
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005208http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005209
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005210 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5211 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5212 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005213
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005214http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5215
5216 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5217 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5218 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5219 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5220 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5221
5222http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5223
5224 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5225 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5226 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5227 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5228 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5229 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5230 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5231 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5232 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5233
5234http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5235
5236 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5237 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5238 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5239 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5240 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5241 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5242 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5243
5244http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5245
5246 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5247 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5248 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5249 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5250 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5251 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5252 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5253 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5254
5255http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5256 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5257
5258 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5259 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5260 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5261 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005262
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005263 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005264 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5265 http-response set-status 431
5266 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5267 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005268
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005269http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005270
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005271 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5272 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5273 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5274 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5275 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5276 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5277 based on some information from the request.
5278
5279 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5280
5281http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5282
5283 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5284 inline.
5285
5286 Arguments:
5287 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5288 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5289 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5290 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5291 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5292 (request and response)
5293 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5294 processing
5295 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5296 processing
5297 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5298 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5299 and '_'.
5300
5301 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5302 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005303
5304 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005305 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005306
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005307http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005308
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005309 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5310 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5311 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5312 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5313 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5314 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5315 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5316 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5317 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5318 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5319 action.
5320 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5321 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5322 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5323 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5324 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005325
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005326http-response strict-mode { on | off }
5327
5328 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5329 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5330 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5331 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5332 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
5333 rewrites optionnal while others must be performed to continue the response
5334 processing.
5335
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005336 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005337 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5338 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
5339 rules evaluation.
5340
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005341http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5342http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5343http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005344
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005345 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5346 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5347 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5348 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5349 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5350 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5351
5352http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5353
5354 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5355 about <var-name>.
5356
5357 Example:
5358 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5359
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005360
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005361http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5362 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5363
5364 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5365 yes | no | yes | yes
5366
5367 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005368 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5369 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5370 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005371
5372 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5373
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005374 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5375 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5376 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5377 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5378 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5379 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5380 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5381 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5382 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5383 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005384
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005385 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5386 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5387 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5388 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5389 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5390 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5391 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5392 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005393
5394 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5395 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5396 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5397 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5398 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5399 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5400 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5401 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005402 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005403 downsides of rare connection failures.
5404
5405 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5406 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5407 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5408 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5409 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5410 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005411 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005412 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5413 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5414 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5415 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5416 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5417
5418 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005419 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5420 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5421 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005422
5423 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005424 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005425
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005426 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5427 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005428
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005429 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005430
5431 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5432 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5433 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5434
5435 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5436
5437
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005438http-send-name-header [<header>]
5439 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005440 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5441 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005442 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005443 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5444
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005445 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5446 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5447 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5448 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5449 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5450 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5451 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5452 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5453 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5454 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5455 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5456 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5457 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5458 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5459 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5460 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005461
5462 See also : "server"
5463
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005464id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005465 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5467 no | yes | yes | yes
5468 Arguments : none
5469
5470 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5471 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5472 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005473
5474
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005475ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5476 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5477 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005478 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005479
5480 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5481 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5482 and running).
5483
5484 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5485 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5486 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005487 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005488 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5489
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005490 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5491 "unless" condition is met.
5492
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005493 Example:
5494 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5495 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5496 ignore-persist if url_static
5497
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005498 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5499
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005500load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5501 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5502 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5503 yes | no | yes | yes
5504
5505 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5506 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5507 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005508 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005509 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5510 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5511 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5512 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5513
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005514 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005515 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005516 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005517
5518 Arguments:
5519 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5520 named "server-state-file".
5521
5522 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5523 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5524 name is used as a file name.
5525
5526 none don't load any stat for this backend
5527
5528 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005529 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5530 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5531 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005532 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005533 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005534
5535 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5536 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5537
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005538 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005539
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005540 global
5541 stats socket /tmp/socket
5542 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005543
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005544 defaults
5545 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005546
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005547 backend bk
5548 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5549 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005550
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005551
5552 Then one can run :
5553
5554 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5555
5556 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5557
5558 1
5559 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5560 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5561 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5562
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005563 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005564
5565 global
5566 stats socket /tmp/socket
5567 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5568
5569 defaults
5570 load-server-state-from-file local
5571
5572 backend bk
5573 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5574 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5575
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005576
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005577 Then one can run :
5578
5579 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5580
5581 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5582
5583 1
5584 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5585 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5586 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5587
5588 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5589 "show servers state"
5590
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005591
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005592log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005593log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5594 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005595no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005596 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5598 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005599
5600 Prefix :
5601 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5602 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5603 prefix does not allow arguments.
5604
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005605 Arguments :
5606 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5607 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5608 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5609 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5610 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5611 parameter.
5612
5613 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5614 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5615
5616 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5617 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5618 standard syslog port).
5619
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005620 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5621 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5622 standard syslog port).
5623
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005624 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5625 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5626 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005627 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005628
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005629 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5630 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5631 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5632 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5633 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5634 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5635 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5636 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5637 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5638 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5639 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5640 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5641 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5642 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5643 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5644 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005645 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5646 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005647
5648 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5649 and "fd@2", see above.
5650
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02005651 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
5652 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
5653 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
5654 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
5655 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
5656 having the logs instantly available.
5657
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005658 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5659 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005660
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005661 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5662 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5663 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5664 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5665 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5666 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5667 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5668 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5669 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5670 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005671 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005672
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005673 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5674 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5675 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5676 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5677 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5678
5679 <sample_size>
5680 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5681 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5682 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5683 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5684 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5685
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005686 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5687 one of the following :
5688
5689 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5690 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5691
5692 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5693 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5694
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005695 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5696 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5697 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5698 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5699 systemd logger consumes.
5700
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005701 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5702 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5703 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5704 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5705
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005706 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5707
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005708 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5709 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5710 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5711
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005712 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5713 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5714 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5715 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005716
5717 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5718 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5719 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005720 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5721 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5722 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5723 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5724 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005725
5726 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5727
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005728 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5729 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5730 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005731
5732 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5733 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5734 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5735 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5736
5737 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5738 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005739
5740 Example :
5741 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005742 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5743 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5744 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005745 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5746 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005747 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005748
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005749
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005750log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005751 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5752 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5753 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005754
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005755 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5756 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5757 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5758 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5759 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005760
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005761 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5762 "option httplog" directives.
5763
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005764log-format-sd <string>
5765 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5766 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5767 yes | yes | yes | no
5768
5769 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5770 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5771 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5772 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5773 which covers the log format string in depth.
5774
5775 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5776 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5777
5778 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5779 log format to "rfc5424".
5780
5781 Example :
5782 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5783
5784
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005785log-tag <string>
5786 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5787 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5788 yes | yes | yes | yes
5789
5790 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5791 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5792 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5793 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5794 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5795 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5796 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5797 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5798 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005799
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005800max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5801 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5802 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5803 yes | no | yes | yes
5804
5805 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5806 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5807 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5808 servers.
5809
5810 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5811 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5812 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5813 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5814 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005815 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005816 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5817 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5818 picking a different server.
5819
5820 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5821 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5822 even if they have to be queued.
5823
5824 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5825 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5826
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005827max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5828 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5829 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5830 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005831
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005832maxconn <conns>
5833 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5835 yes | yes | yes | no
5836 Arguments :
5837 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5838 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5839 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5840 closes.
5841
5842 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5843 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5844 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5845 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005846 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5847 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5848 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5849 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005850
5851 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5852 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5853 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5854
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005855 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5856 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005857
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005858 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5859
5860
5861mode { tcp|http|health }
5862 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5864 yes | yes | yes | yes
5865 Arguments :
5866 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5867 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5868 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5869 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5870
5871 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5872 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5873 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5874 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5875 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5876
5877 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005878 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5879 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5880 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5881 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5882 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5883 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5884 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005885
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005886 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5887 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5888 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005889
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005890 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005891 defaults http_instances
5892 mode http
5893
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005894 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005895
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005896
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005897monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005898 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5900 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005901 Arguments :
5902 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5903 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005904 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005905 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5906 backend and its backup.
5907
5908 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5909 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5910 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5911 servers in a list of backends.
5912
5913 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5914 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5915 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5916 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5917 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5918 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5919 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005920 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5921 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005922
5923 Example:
5924 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005925 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005926 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5927 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5928 monitor-uri /site_alive
5929 monitor fail if site_dead
5930
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005931 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005932
5933
5934monitor-net <source>
5935 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5937 yes | yes | yes | no
5938 Arguments :
5939 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5940 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5941 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5942 followed by a mask.
5943
5944 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5945 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005946 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005947 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5948
5949 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5950 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5951 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5952 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005953 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5954 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5955 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005956
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005957 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5958 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5959 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5960 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5961 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5962 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005963
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005964 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5965 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005966
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005967 Example :
5968 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5969 frontend www
5970 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5971
5972 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5973
5974
5975monitor-uri <uri>
5976 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5978 yes | yes | yes | no
5979 Arguments :
5980 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5981 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5982
5983 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5984 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5985 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5986 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5987 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5988 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5989 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5990 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5991
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005992 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005993 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
5994 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5995 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5996 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5997 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5998 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005999
6000 Example :
6001 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6002 frontend www
6003 mode http
6004 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6005
6006 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6007
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006008
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006009option abortonclose
6010no option abortonclose
6011 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6013 yes | no | yes | yes
6014 Arguments : none
6015
6016 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6017 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6018 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6019 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006020 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006021 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6022 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6023 encountered while delivering the response.
6024
6025 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6026 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6027 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6028 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6029 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6030 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006031 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006032 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006033 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006034 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6035 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6036 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6037
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006038 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6039 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006040 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6041 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6042 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6043 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6044 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6045 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006046 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006047
6048 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6049 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6050
6051 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6052
6053
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006054option accept-invalid-http-request
6055no option accept-invalid-http-request
6056 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6058 yes | yes | yes | no
6059 Arguments : none
6060
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006061 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006062 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006063 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006064 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6065 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6066 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6067 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6068 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006069 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6070 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6071 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6072 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006073 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006074 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006075 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6076 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6077 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006078
6079 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6080 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6081 been confirmed.
6082
6083 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6084 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006085 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6086 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006087 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6088
6089 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6090 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6091
6092 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6093 stats socket.
6094
6095
6096option accept-invalid-http-response
6097no option accept-invalid-http-response
6098 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6100 yes | no | yes | yes
6101 Arguments : none
6102
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006103 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006104 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006105 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006106 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6107 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6108 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6109 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6110 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006111 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6112 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6113 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006114
6115 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6116 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6117 been confirmed.
6118
6119 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6120 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6121 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6122 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6123
6124 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6125 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6126
6127 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6128 stats socket.
6129
6130
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006131option allbackups
6132no option allbackups
6133 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6135 yes | no | yes | yes
6136 Arguments : none
6137
6138 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6139 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6140 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6141 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6142 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6143 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6144 order between the backup servers anymore.
6145
6146 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6147 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6148
6149 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6150 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6151
6152
6153option checkcache
6154no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006155 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6157 yes | no | yes | yes
6158 Arguments : none
6159
6160 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6161 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006162 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006163 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6164 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006165 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006166
6167 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006168 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006169 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006170 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6171 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006172 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006173 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006174 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6175 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006176 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006177 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6178 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006179 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006180 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6181 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6182 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6183 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6184 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6185 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6186 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6187 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6188 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6189
6190 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006191 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
6192 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
6193 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
6194 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006195
6196 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6197 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006198 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006199 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006200
6201 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6202 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6203
6204
6205option clitcpka
6206no option clitcpka
6207 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6209 yes | yes | yes | no
6210 Arguments : none
6211
6212 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6213 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006214 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006215 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6216
6217 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6218 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6219 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6220 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6221
6222 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6223 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6224 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6225 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6226 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6227
6228 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6229
6230 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6231 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6232 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6233
6234 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6235 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6236
6237 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6238
6239
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006240option contstats
6241 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6243 yes | yes | yes | no
6244 Arguments : none
6245
6246 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6247 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6248 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6249 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006250 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6251 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6252 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6253 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6254 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006255
6256
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006257option dontlog-normal
6258no option dontlog-normal
6259 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6261 yes | yes | yes | no
6262 Arguments : none
6263
6264 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6265 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6266 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6267 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6268 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6269 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6270 logged.
6271
6272 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6273 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6274 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6275
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006276 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006277 logging.
6278
6279
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006280option dontlognull
6281no option dontlognull
6282 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6284 yes | yes | yes | no
6285 Arguments : none
6286
6287 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6288 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6289 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6290 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6291 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6292 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006293 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6294 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6295 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006296
6297 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006298 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006299 would not be logged.
6300
6301 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6302 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6303
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006304 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6305 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006306
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006307
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006308option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006309 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6311 yes | yes | yes | yes
6312 Arguments :
6313 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6314 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006315 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006316 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006317
6318 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6319 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6320 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6321 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6322 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6323 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6324 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006325 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6326 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6327 possible that the client has already brought one.
6328
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006329 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006330 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006331 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006332 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006333 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006334 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006335
6336 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6337 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6338 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6339 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6340 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6341 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6342 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6343
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006344 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6345 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6346 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6347 are under the control of the end-user.
6348
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006349 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006350 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6351 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006352 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6353 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6354 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006355
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006356 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006357 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6358 frontend www
6359 mode http
6360 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6361
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006362 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6363 backend www
6364 mode http
6365 option forwardfor header X-Client
6366
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006367 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006368 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006369
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006370
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006371option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6372no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6373 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6375 yes | yes | yes | no
6376 Arguments : none
6377
6378 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6379 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6380 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6381 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6382 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6383 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6384 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6385
6386 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6387 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6388 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6389 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6390 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6391 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6392 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6393 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6394 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6395 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6396
6397 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6398
6399 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6400 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6401
6402 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6403 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6404
6405
6406option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6407no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6408 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6410 yes | no | yes | yes
6411 Arguments : none
6412
6413 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6414 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6415 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6416 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6417 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6418 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6419 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6420
6421 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6422 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6423 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6424 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6425 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6426 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6427 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6428 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6429 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6430 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6431
6432 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6433
6434 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6435 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6436
6437 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6438 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6439
6440
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006441option http-buffer-request
6442no option http-buffer-request
6443 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6445 yes | yes | yes | yes
6446 Arguments : none
6447
6448 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6449 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6450 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6451 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6452 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6453 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01006454 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
6455 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
6456 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
6457 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006458
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006459 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006460
6461
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006462option http-ignore-probes
6463no option http-ignore-probes
6464 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6466 yes | yes | yes | no
6467 Arguments : none
6468
6469 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6470 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6471 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6472 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6473 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6474 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6475 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6476 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6477 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006478 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6479 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006480 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6481
6482 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6483 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6484 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6485 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6486 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6487 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6488 are often the only way to detect them.
6489
6490 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6491 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6492
6493 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6494
6495
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006496option http-keep-alive
6497no option http-keep-alive
6498 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6500 yes | yes | yes | yes
6501 Arguments : none
6502
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006503 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6504 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006505 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6506 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006507 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
6508 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
6509 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006510
6511 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6512 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006513 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6514 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6515 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6516 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6517 situations where this option may be useful :
6518
6519 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006520 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006521
6522 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6523 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6524
6525 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6526 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6527 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6528 request.
6529
6530 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6531 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006532 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6533 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6534 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006535
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006536 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6537 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6538 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6539 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6540 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6541 not set.
6542
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006543 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6544 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
6545 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006546
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006547 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006548 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006549 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006550
6551
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006552option http-no-delay
6553no option http-no-delay
6554 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6556 yes | yes | yes | yes
6557 Arguments : none
6558
6559 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6560 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6561 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6562 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6563 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6564 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6565 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6566 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6567 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6568 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6569 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6570 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6571 affected.
6572
6573 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6574 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6575 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6576 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6577 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6578 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6579 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6580 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6581 latency environments.
6582
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006583 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6584
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006585
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006586option http-pretend-keepalive
6587no option http-pretend-keepalive
6588 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006590 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006591 Arguments : none
6592
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006593 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006594 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6595 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6596 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6597 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6598 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6599 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6600 consider the response complete.
6601
6602 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6603 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6604 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6605 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006606 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006607 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6608
6609 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6610 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6611 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6612 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6613 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6614 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6615 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6616
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006617 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6618 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6619 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6620 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6621 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6622 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006623
6624 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6625 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6626
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006627 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006628 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006629
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006630
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006631option http-server-close
6632no option http-server-close
6633 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6635 yes | yes | yes | yes
6636 Arguments : none
6637
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006638 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6639 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6640 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6641 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006642 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
6643 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
6644 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
6645 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
6646 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
6647 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
6648 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
6649 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
6650 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
6651 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
6652 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006653
6654 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6655 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6656 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6657 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006658 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6659 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006660
6661 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6662 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006663 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
6664 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6665 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006666
6667 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6668 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6669
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006670 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6671 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006672
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006673option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006674no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006675 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6677 yes | yes | yes | no
6678 Arguments : none
6679
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006680 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006681 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6682 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6683 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6684 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6685 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6686 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6687
6688 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6689 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006690 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6691 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6692 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006693
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006694 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6695 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6696 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6697 front of an existing proxy.
6698
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006699 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6700
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006701 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006702
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006703option httpchk
6704option httpchk <uri>
6705option httpchk <method> <uri>
6706option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6707 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6709 yes | no | yes | yes
6710 Arguments :
6711 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6712 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6713 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6714 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6715 ones.
6716
6717 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6718 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6719 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6720
6721 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6722 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6723 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6724 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6725 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6726
6727 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6728 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6729 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6730 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6731 the lack of any response.
6732
6733 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6734
6735 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6736 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6737 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6738
6739 Examples :
6740 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6741 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6742 backend https_relay
6743 mode tcp
6744 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6745 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6746
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006747 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6748 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6749 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006750
6751
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006752option httpclose
6753no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006754 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6756 yes | yes | yes | yes
6757 Arguments : none
6758
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006759 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6760 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6761 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6762 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006763 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006764
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006765 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6766 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006767 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006768 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6769 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006770
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006771 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6772 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6773 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006774
6775 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6776 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02006777 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
6778 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
6779 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006780
6781 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6782 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6783
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006784 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006785
6786
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006787option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006788 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006790 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006791 Arguments :
6792 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6793 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6794 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006795 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006796 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006797
6798 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6799 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6800 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6801 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6802 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6803 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6804 ports.
6805
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006806 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6807 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006808
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006809 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6810
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006811 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006812
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006813
6814option http_proxy
6815no option http_proxy
6816 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6818 yes | yes | yes | yes
6819 Arguments : none
6820
6821 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6822 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6823 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6824 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6825 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6826
6827 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6828 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006829 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6830 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006831
6832 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6833 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6834
6835 Example :
6836 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6837 backend direct_forward
6838 option httpclose
6839 option http_proxy
6840
6841 See also : "option httpclose"
6842
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006843
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006844option independent-streams
6845no option independent-streams
6846 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6848 yes | yes | yes | yes
6849 Arguments : none
6850
6851 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6852 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6853 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6854 receive data or not.
6855
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006856 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006857 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6858 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6859 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6860 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6861 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6862 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6863 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6864 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6865 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6866 socket buffers.
6867
6868 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6869 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6870 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6871 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6872 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6873
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006874 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006875
6876
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006877option ldap-check
6878 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6880 yes | no | yes | yes
6881 Arguments : none
6882
6883 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6884 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6885 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6886 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6887
6888 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6889 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6890
6891 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6892 configure it.
6893
6894 Example :
6895 option ldap-check
6896
6897 See also : "option httpchk"
6898
6899
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006900option external-check
6901 Use external processes for server health checks
6902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6903 yes | no | yes | yes
6904
6905 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6906 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6907 command".
6908
6909 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6910
6911 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6912
6913
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006914option log-health-checks
6915no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006916 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6918 yes | no | yes | yes
6919 Arguments : none
6920
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006921 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6922 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6923 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006924
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006925 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6926 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6927 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6928 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6929 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6930
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006931 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006932 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006933
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006934 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6935 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6936 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006937
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006938
6939option log-separate-errors
6940no option log-separate-errors
6941 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6943 yes | yes | yes | no
6944 Arguments : none
6945
6946 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6947 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6948 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6949 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6950 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6951 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6952 provides very important information.
6953
6954 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6955 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6956 error logs.
6957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006958 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006959 logging.
6960
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006961
6962option logasap
6963no option logasap
6964 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6966 yes | yes | yes | no
6967 Arguments : none
6968
6969 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6970 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6971 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6972 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6973 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6974 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6975 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006976 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006977 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6978 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6979
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006980 Examples :
6981 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6982 mode http
6983 option httplog
6984 option logasap
6985 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6986
6987 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6988 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6989 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6990 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006992 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006993 logging.
6994
6995
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006996option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006997 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6999 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007000 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007001 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7002 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007003 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007004
7005 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7006 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007007 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007008 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7009 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7010 in the MySQL table, like this :
7011
7012 USE mysql;
7013 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7014 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7015
7016 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007017 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007018 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7019 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7020 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7021 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7022 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7023 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7024 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7025
7026 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7027 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007028
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007029 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007030
7031 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7032 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7033 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7034 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007035 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7036 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007037
7038 See also: "option httpchk"
7039
7040
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007041option nolinger
7042no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007043 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007044 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7045 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007046 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007047
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007048 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007049 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7050 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7051 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7052 connections.
7053
7054 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7055 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7056 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7057 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7058 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7059 this too.
7060
7061 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7062 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7063 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7064
7065 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7066 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7067 for servers.
7068
7069 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7070 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7071
7072
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007073option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7074 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7076 yes | yes | yes | yes
7077 Arguments :
7078 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7079 matching <network>
7080 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7081 header name.
7082
7083 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7084 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7085 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7086 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7087 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7088 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7089 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7090 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7091 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7092 possible that the client has already brought one.
7093
7094 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7095 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7096 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7097 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7098 header and requires different one.
7099
7100 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7101 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7102 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7103 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7104 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7105 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7106 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7107
7108 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7109 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7110 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7111 both are defined.
7112
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007113 Examples :
7114 # Original Destination address
7115 frontend www
7116 mode http
7117 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7118
7119 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7120 backend www
7121 mode http
7122 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7123
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007124 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007125
7126
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007127option persist
7128no option persist
7129 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7130 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7131 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007132 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007133
7134 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7135 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7136 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7137 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7138 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7139 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7140 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7141 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7142 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7143 redirected to another valid server.
7144
7145 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7146 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7147
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007148 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007149
7150
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007151option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7152 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7154 yes | no | yes | yes
7155 Arguments :
7156 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7157 PostgreSQL server.
7158
7159 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7160 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7161 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7162 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7163
7164 See also: "option httpchk"
7165
7166
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007167option prefer-last-server
7168no option prefer-last-server
7169 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7170 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7171 yes | no | yes | yes
7172 Arguments : none
7173
7174 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7175 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7176 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7177 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7178 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7179 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7180 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7181 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7182 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007183 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7184 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007185 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7186 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7187 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007188 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7189 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7190 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007191
7192 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7193 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7194
7195 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7196
7197
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007198option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007199option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007200no option redispatch
7201 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7202 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7203 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007204 Arguments :
7205 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7206 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7207 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007208 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007209 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007210 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007211 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7212 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7213 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7214
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007215
7216 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7217 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7218 be able to access the service anymore.
7219
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007220 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7221 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007222
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007223 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007224 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7225 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007226
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007227 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7228 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7229
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007230 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007231
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007232
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007233option redis-check
7234 Use redis health checks for server testing
7235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7236 yes | no | yes | yes
7237 Arguments : none
7238
7239 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7240 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7241 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7242 find the "+PONG" response message.
7243
7244 Example :
7245 option redis-check
7246
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007247 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007248
7249
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007250option smtpchk
7251option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7252 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7254 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007255 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007256 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007257 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007258 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7259
7260 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7261 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7262 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7263
7264 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7265 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7266 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7267 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7268 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7269 dead server.
7270
7271 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7272 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007273 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007274 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7275
7276 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7277 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7278 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7279 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007280 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007281
7282 Example :
7283 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7284
7285 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7286
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007287
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007288option socket-stats
7289no option socket-stats
7290
7291 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7293 yes | yes | yes | no
7294
7295 Arguments : none
7296
7297
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007298option splice-auto
7299no option splice-auto
7300 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7302 yes | yes | yes | yes
7303 Arguments : none
7304
7305 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7306 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007307 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007308 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007309 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007310 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7311 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7312 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7313 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7314
7315 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7316 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7317 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7318 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7319 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7320 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7321 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7322 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7323 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7324 keyword.
7325
7326 Example :
7327 option splice-auto
7328
7329 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7330 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7331
7332 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7333 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7334
7335
7336option splice-request
7337no option splice-request
7338 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7340 yes | yes | yes | yes
7341 Arguments : none
7342
7343 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007344 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007345 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7346 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7347 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7348 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7349
7350 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7351
7352 Example :
7353 option splice-request
7354
7355 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7356 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7357
7358 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7359 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7360
7361
7362option splice-response
7363no option splice-response
7364 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7366 yes | yes | yes | yes
7367 Arguments : none
7368
7369 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007370 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007371 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7372 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7373 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7374 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7375
7376 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7377
7378 Example :
7379 option splice-response
7380
7381 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7382 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7383
7384 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7385 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7386
7387
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007388option spop-check
7389 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7391 no | no | no | yes
7392 Arguments : none
7393
7394 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7395 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7396 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7397 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7398
7399 Example :
7400 option spop-check
7401
7402 See also : "option httpchk"
7403
7404
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007405option srvtcpka
7406no option srvtcpka
7407 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7409 yes | no | yes | yes
7410 Arguments : none
7411
7412 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7413 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007414 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007415 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7416
7417 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7418 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7419 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7420 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7421
7422 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7423 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7424 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7425 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7426 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7427
7428 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7429
7430 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7431 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7432 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7433
7434 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7435 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7436
7437 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7438
7439
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007440option ssl-hello-chk
7441 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7443 yes | no | yes | yes
7444 Arguments : none
7445
7446 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7447 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7448 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7449 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7450 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7451 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7452 hello message.
7453
7454 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7455 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7456 messages, which is appreciable.
7457
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007458 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7459 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7460 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007461
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007462 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7463
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007464
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007465option tcp-check
7466 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7467 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7468 yes | no | yes | yes
7469
7470 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7471 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7472
7473 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7474 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7475 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7476
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007477 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007478 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7479 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7480 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7481 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7482 only.
7483
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007484 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007485 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7486 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7487 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7488 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7489
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007490 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007491 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7492 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007493 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007494 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7495 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7496 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7497 the respective protocols.
7498 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007499 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007500
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007501 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7502 script.
7503
7504 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7505 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7506 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7507 The "comment" is of course optional.
7508
7509
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007510 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007511 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007512 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007513 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007514
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007515 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007516 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007517 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007518
7519 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7520 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007521 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007522 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007523 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007524 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007525 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007526 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007527 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7528 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007529 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007530 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7531 tcp-check expect string +OK
7532
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007533 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007534 (send many headers before analyzing)
7535 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007536 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007537 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7538 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7539 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7540 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007541 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007542
7543
7544 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7545
7546
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007547option tcp-smart-accept
7548no option tcp-smart-accept
7549 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7551 yes | yes | yes | no
7552 Arguments : none
7553
7554 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7555 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7556 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7557 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7558 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7559 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7560
7561 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7562 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7563 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7564 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7565
7566 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7567 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7568 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007569 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007570
7571 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7572 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7573 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7574
7575 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7576 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7577 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7578
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007579 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7580
7581
7582option tcp-smart-connect
7583no option tcp-smart-connect
7584 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7586 yes | no | yes | yes
7587 Arguments : none
7588
7589 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7590 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7591 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7592 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7593 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7594
7595 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7596 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7597 complex.
7598
7599 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7600 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7601 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7602
7603 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7604 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7605
7606 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7607
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007608
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007609option tcpka
7610 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7612 yes | yes | yes | yes
7613 Arguments : none
7614
7615 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7616 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007617 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007618 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7619
7620 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7621 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7622 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7623 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7624
7625 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7626 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7627 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7628 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7629 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7630
7631 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7632
7633 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7634 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7635 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7636 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7637 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7638 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7639 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7640 backends.
7641
7642 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7643
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007644
7645option tcplog
7646 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007648 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007649 Arguments : none
7650
7651 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7652 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7653 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7654 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7655 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7656 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7657 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7658 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7659
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007660 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7661
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007662 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007663
7664
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007665option transparent
7666no option transparent
7667 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007669 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007670 Arguments : none
7671
7672 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7673 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7674 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7675 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7676 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7677 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7678 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7679 appropriate server.
7680
7681 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7682 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7683
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007684 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007685 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007686
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007687
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007688external-check command <command>
7689 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7691 yes | no | yes | yes
7692
7693 Arguments :
7694 <command> is the external command to run
7695
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007696 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7697
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007698 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007699
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007700 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7701 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7702 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7703 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7704 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7705 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007706
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007707 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7708
7709 Environment variables :
7710 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7711 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7712
7713 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7714
7715 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7716
7717 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7718 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7719 for a UNIX socket).
7720
7721 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7722
7723 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7724
7725 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7726
7727 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7728
7729 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7730
7731 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7732 socket).
7733
7734 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7735 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7736
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007737 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7738
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007739 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7740 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7741 failed.
7742
7743 Example :
7744 external-check command /bin/true
7745
7746 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7747
7748
7749external-check path <path>
7750 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7752 yes | no | yes | yes
7753
7754 Arguments :
7755 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7756
7757 The default path is "".
7758
7759 Example :
7760 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7761
7762 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7763 "external-check command"
7764
7765
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007766persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007767persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007768 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7770 yes | no | yes | yes
7771 Arguments :
7772 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007773 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7774 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007775
7776 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7777 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007778 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007779 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7780 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7781 forwarded to this server.
7782
7783 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7784 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7785 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007786 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007787 a single "listen" section.
7788
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007789 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7790 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7791 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7792
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007793 Example :
7794 listen tse-farm
7795 bind :3389
7796 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7797 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7798 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7799 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7800 persist rdp-cookie
7801 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007802 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007803 balance rdp-cookie
7804 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7805 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7806
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007807 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7808 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007809
7810
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007811rate-limit sessions <rate>
7812 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7814 yes | yes | yes | no
7815 Arguments :
7816 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7817 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7818
7819 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7820 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7821 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7822 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7823 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7824 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7825
7826 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7827 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7828 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7829 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7830
7831 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7832 listen smtp
7833 mode tcp
7834 bind :25
7835 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007836 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007837
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007838 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7839 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7840 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007841
7842 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7843
7844
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007845redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7846redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7847redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007848 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7850 no | yes | yes | yes
7851
7852 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007853 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007854
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007855 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007856 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007857 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7858 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7859 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007860
7861 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7862 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7863 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7864 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7865 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007866 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7867 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7868 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7869 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007870
7871 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7872 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7873 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7874 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7875 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7876 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007877 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007878 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007879 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7880 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7881 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007882
7883 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007884 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7885 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7886 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007887 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007888 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7889 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7890 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7891 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007892
7893 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007894 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007895
7896 - "drop-query"
7897 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7898 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7899 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7900 with a location-type redirect.
7901
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007902 - "append-slash"
7903 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7904 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7905 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7906 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7907
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007908 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7909 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7910 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7911 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7912 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7913 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7914 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7915
7916 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7917 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7918 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7919 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7920 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7921 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7922 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007923
7924 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7925 acl clear dst_port 80
7926 acl secure dst_port 8080
7927 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007928 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007929 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007930 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7931
7932 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007933 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7934 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7935 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007936 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007937
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007938 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7939 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7940 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7941
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007942 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007943 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007944
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007945 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007946 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7947 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7948 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007949
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007950 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007951
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007952
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007953retries <value>
7954 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7955 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7956 yes | no | yes | yes
7957 Arguments :
7958 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7959 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7960 default value is 3.
7961
7962 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7963 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7964 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7965
7966 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007967 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7968 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007969
7970 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7971 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7972
7973 See also : "option redispatch"
7974
7975
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02007976retry-on [list of keywords]
7977 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
7978 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7979 yes | no | yes | yes
7980 Arguments :
7981 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
7982 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
7983 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
7984 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
7985
7986 none never retry
7987
7988 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
7989 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
7990
7991 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
7992 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
7993 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
7994 request timeout on the server side, poor network
7995 condition, or a server crash or restart while
7996 processing the request.
7997
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02007998 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
7999 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8000 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8001 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8002 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8003 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8004 overflow attack for example).
8005
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008006 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8007 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8008 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8009 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8010 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8011 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8012 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8013 amplify denial of service attacks.
8014
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008015 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8016 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8017 considered to be safe to retry.
8018
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008019 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8020 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8021 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8022 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8023
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008024 all-retryable-errors
8025 retry request for any error that are considered
8026 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8027 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8028 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8029
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008030 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8031 not cumulative.
8032
8033 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8034 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8035 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8036 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8037
8038 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8039 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8040 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8041 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8042 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8043 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8044 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8045 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8046 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8047 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8048 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8049 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8050
8051 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8052 should not use this directive.
8053
8054 The default is "conn-failure".
8055
8056 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8057
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008058server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008059 Declare a server in a backend
8060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8061 no | no | yes | yes
8062 Arguments :
8063 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008064 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008065 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008066
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008067 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8068 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8069 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8070 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008071 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8072 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8073 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8074 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8075 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008076 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8077 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8078 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8079 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8080 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8081 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8082 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008083 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008084 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8085 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8086 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8087 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8088 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8089 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008090 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8091 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008092 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8093 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008094
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008095 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008096 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8097 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8098 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8099 adding this value to the client's port.
8100
8101 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8102 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008103 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008104
8105 Examples :
8106 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8107 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008108 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008109 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8110 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8111 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008112
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008113 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8114 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8115 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8116 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8117 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8118
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008119 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8120 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008121
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008122server-state-file-name [<file>]
8123 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8124 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8125 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8126 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8127 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8128 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8129
8130 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8131 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8132
8133 global
8134 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8135
8136 backend bk
8137 load-server-state-from-file
8138
8139 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8140 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008141
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008142server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8143 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8144 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8146 no | no | yes | yes
8147
8148 Arguments:
8149 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8150
8151 <num | range>
8152 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8153 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8154 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8155 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8156
8157 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8158
8159 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8160
8161 <params*>
8162 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8163 keyword.
8164
8165 Examples:
8166 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8167 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8168 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8169
8170 # or
8171 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8172
8173 # would be equivalent to:
8174 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8175 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8176 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8177
8178
8179
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008180source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008181source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008182source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008183 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8185 yes | no | yes | yes
8186 Arguments :
8187 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8188 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008189
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008190 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008191 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8192 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8193 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8194 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8195 supported prefixes are :
8196 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8197 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8198 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008199 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008200 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8201 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008202
8203 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8204 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008205 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8206 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8207 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008208
8209 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8210 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8211 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8212 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8213 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8214 <addr>.
8215
8216 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8217 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8218 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8219 port.
8220
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008221 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8222 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8223 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8224 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008225 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008226 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8227 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8228 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8229 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8230 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8231 HTTP header.
8232
8233 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8234 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008235 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008236 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8237 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8238 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8239 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8240 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8241 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8242 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8243
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008244 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8245 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8246 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8247 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8248 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8249 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8250
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008251 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8252 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8253 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8254 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8255
8256 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8257 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8258 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8259 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8260 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8261 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8262
8263 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8264 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8265 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8266 there are two methods :
8267
8268 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8269 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8270 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8271 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8272 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8273 of the client ranges may be used.
8274
8275 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8276 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8277 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8278 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8279 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8280 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8281 same session.
8282
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008283 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8284 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8285 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008286 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008287
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008288 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8289
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008290 Examples :
8291 backend private
8292 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8293 source 192.168.1.200
8294
8295 backend transparent_ssl1
8296 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8297 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8298
8299 backend transparent_ssl2
8300 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8301 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8302 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8303
8304 backend transparent_ssl3
8305 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8306 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8307 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8308
8309 backend transparent_smtp
8310 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8311 # with Tproxy version 4.
8312 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8313
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008314 backend transparent_http
8315 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8316 # proxy.
8317 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8318
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008319 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008320 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8321
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008322
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008323stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8324 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008326 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008327
8328 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8329 matched.
8330
8331 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8332 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8333
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008334 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8335 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008336 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008337
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008338 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8339 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8340 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8341 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008342
8343 Example :
8344 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8345 backend stats_localhost
8346 stats enable
8347 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8348
8349 Example :
8350 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8351 backend stats_auth
8352 stats enable
8353 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8354 stats admin if TRUE
8355
8356 Example :
8357 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8358 userlist stats-auth
8359 group admin users admin
8360 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8361 group readonly users haproxy
8362 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8363
8364 backend stats_auth
8365 stats enable
8366 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8367 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8368 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8369 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8370
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008371 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8372 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8373 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008374
8375
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008376stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8377 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008379 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008380 Arguments :
8381 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8382
8383 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8384
8385 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8386 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8387 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8388 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8389 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8390 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8391
8392 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8393 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8394 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008395 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008396
8397 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8398 report using "stats scope".
8399
8400 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8401 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8402 unobvious parameters.
8403
8404 Example :
8405 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8406 backend public_www
8407 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8408 stats enable
8409 stats hide-version
8410 stats scope .
8411 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008412 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008413 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8414 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8415
8416 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8417 backend private_monitoring
8418 stats enable
8419 stats uri /admin?stats
8420 stats refresh 5s
8421
8422 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8423
8424
8425stats enable
8426 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008428 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008429 Arguments : none
8430
8431 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8432 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8433 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8434 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8435 - stats auth : no authentication
8436 - stats scope : no restriction
8437
8438 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8439 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8440 unobvious parameters.
8441
8442 Example :
8443 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8444 backend public_www
8445 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8446 stats enable
8447 stats hide-version
8448 stats scope .
8449 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008450 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008451 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8452 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8453
8454 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8455 backend private_monitoring
8456 stats enable
8457 stats uri /admin?stats
8458 stats refresh 5s
8459
8460 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8461
8462
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008463stats hide-version
8464 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008466 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008467 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008468
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008469 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8470 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8471 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8472 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8473 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8474 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008475
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008476 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8477 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8478 unobvious parameters.
8479
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008480 Example :
8481 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8482 backend public_www
8483 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008484 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008485 stats hide-version
8486 stats scope .
8487 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008488 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008489 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8490 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008491
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008492 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8493 backend private_monitoring
8494 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008495 stats uri /admin?stats
8496 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008497
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008498 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008499
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008500
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008501stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8502 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8503 Access control for statistics
8504
8505 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8506 no | no | yes | yes
8507
8508 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8509 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8510 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8511 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8512 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8513 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8514
8515 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8516 instance.
8517
8518 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8519 about ACL usage.
8520
8521
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008522stats realm <realm>
8523 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008525 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008526 Arguments :
8527 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8528 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8529 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8530
8531 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8532 using a backslash ('\').
8533
8534 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8535 only related to authentication.
8536
8537 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8538 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8539 unobvious parameters.
8540
8541 Example :
8542 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8543 backend public_www
8544 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8545 stats enable
8546 stats hide-version
8547 stats scope .
8548 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008549 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008550 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8551 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8552
8553 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8554 backend private_monitoring
8555 stats enable
8556 stats uri /admin?stats
8557 stats refresh 5s
8558
8559 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8560
8561
8562stats refresh <delay>
8563 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008565 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008566 Arguments :
8567 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8568 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8569 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8570 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8571 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8572 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8573
8574 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8575 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8576 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8577 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8578
8579 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8580 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8581 unobvious parameters.
8582
8583 Example :
8584 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8585 backend public_www
8586 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8587 stats enable
8588 stats hide-version
8589 stats scope .
8590 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008591 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008592 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8593 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8594
8595 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8596 backend private_monitoring
8597 stats enable
8598 stats uri /admin?stats
8599 stats refresh 5s
8600
8601 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8602
8603
8604stats scope { <name> | "." }
8605 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008607 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008608 Arguments :
8609 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8610 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8611 section in which the statement appears.
8612
8613 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8614 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8615 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8616 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8617 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8618 exists.
8619
8620 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8621 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8622 unobvious parameters.
8623
8624 Example :
8625 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8626 backend public_www
8627 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8628 stats enable
8629 stats hide-version
8630 stats scope .
8631 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008632 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008633 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8634 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8635
8636 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8637 backend private_monitoring
8638 stats enable
8639 stats uri /admin?stats
8640 stats refresh 5s
8641
8642 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8643
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008644
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008645stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008646 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008648 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008649
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008650 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008651 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8652
8653 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8654 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8655
8656 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8657 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008658 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008659
8660 Example :
8661 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8662 backend private_monitoring
8663 stats enable
8664 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8665 stats uri /admin?stats
8666 stats refresh 5s
8667
8668 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8669 global section.
8670
8671
8672stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008673 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8675 yes | yes | yes | yes
8676 Arguments : none
8677
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008678 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008679 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8680 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8681 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8682 - IP (socket, server)
8683 - cookie (backend, server)
8684
8685 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8686 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008687 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008688
8689 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8690
8691
8692stats show-node [ <name> ]
8693 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008695 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008696 Arguments:
8697 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8698 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8699
8700 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8701 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008702 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008703
8704 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8705 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8706 unobvious parameters.
8707
8708 Example:
8709 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8710 backend private_monitoring
8711 stats enable
8712 stats show-node Europe-1
8713 stats uri /admin?stats
8714 stats refresh 5s
8715
8716 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8717 section.
8718
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008719
8720stats uri <prefix>
8721 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008723 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008724 Arguments :
8725 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8726 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8727 query string.
8728
8729 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8730 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8731 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8732 possible to reach it in the application.
8733
8734 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008735 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008736 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8737 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8738 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8739 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8740
8741 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8742 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8743 an address or a port to statistics only.
8744
8745 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8746 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8747 unobvious parameters.
8748
8749 Example :
8750 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8751 backend public_www
8752 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8753 stats enable
8754 stats hide-version
8755 stats scope .
8756 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008757 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008758 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8759 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8760
8761 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8762 backend private_monitoring
8763 stats enable
8764 stats uri /admin?stats
8765 stats refresh 5s
8766
8767 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8768
8769
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008770stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8771 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008773 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008774
8775 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008776 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008777 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008778 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008779 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8780
8781 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8782 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8783 the "stick-table" statement.
8784
8785 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8786 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8787 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8788 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8789 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8790
8791 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8792 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8793 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8794 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8795 transformation rules.
8796
8797 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8798 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8799 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8800 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8801 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8802 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8803 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8804
8805 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8806 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8807 ACL based conditions.
8808
8809 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8810 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8811 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8812 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8813
8814 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8815 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8816 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8817 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8818
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008819 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8820 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008821 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008822
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008823 Example :
8824 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8825 # last 30 minutes
8826 backend pop
8827 mode tcp
8828 balance roundrobin
8829 stick store-request src
8830 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8831 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8832 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8833
8834 backend smtp
8835 mode tcp
8836 balance roundrobin
8837 stick match src table pop
8838 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8839 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8840
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008841 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008842 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008843
8844
8845stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8846 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8848 no | no | yes | yes
8849
8850 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8851 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8852 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8853 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8854
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008855 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8856 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008857 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008858
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008859 Examples :
8860 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008861 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008862
8863 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8864 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8865 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8866
8867
8868 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8869 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8870 backend http
8871 mode http
8872 balance roundrobin
8873 stick on src table https
8874 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8875 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8876 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8877
8878 backend https
8879 mode tcp
8880 balance roundrobin
8881 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8882 stick on src
8883 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8884 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8885
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008886 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008887
8888
8889stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8890 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8892 no | no | yes | yes
8893
8894 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008895 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008896 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008897 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008898 server is selected.
8899
8900 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8901 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8902 the "stick-table" statement.
8903
8904 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8905 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8906 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8907 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8908 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8909 address.
8910
8911 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8912 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8913 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8914 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8915 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8916 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8917 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8918 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8919 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8920 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8921
8922 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8923 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8924 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8925 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8926 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8927 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8928 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8929
8930 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8931 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8932 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8933 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8934
8935 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8936 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8937 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8938 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8939 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8940 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008941 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8942 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8943 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8944 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8945 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8946 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008947
8948 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8949 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8950 the request.
8951
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008952 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8953 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008954 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008955
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008956 Example :
8957 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8958 # last 30 minutes
8959 backend pop
8960 mode tcp
8961 balance roundrobin
8962 stick store-request src
8963 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8964 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8965 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8966
8967 backend smtp
8968 mode tcp
8969 balance roundrobin
8970 stick match src table pop
8971 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8972 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8973
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008974 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008975 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008976
8977
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008978stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008979 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8980 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008981 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008983 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008984
8985 Arguments :
8986 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8987 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8988 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8989 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8990
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008991 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8992 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8993 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8994 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8995
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008996 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8997 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8998 instance.
8999
9000 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9001 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9002 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9003 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9004 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9005 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009006 to 32 characters.
9007
9008 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9009 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9010 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009011 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009012 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9013 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009014
9015 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009016 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9017 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009018 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9019 increase.
9020
9021 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009022 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9023 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9024 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009025
9026 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9027 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9028 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9029 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009030 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009031 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9032 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9033 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9034 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9035 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9036 parameter (see below).
9037
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009038 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9039 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9040 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9041 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9042 soft restart.
9043
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009044 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9045 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009046
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009047 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9048 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9049 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9050 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009051 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009052 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009053 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9054 if not expiration delay is specified.
9055
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009056 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9057 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9058 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9059 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009060 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9061 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9062 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9063 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9064 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9065 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9066 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9067 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9068 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9069 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9070 types and their arguments.
9071
9072 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9073 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9074 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9075 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9076
9077 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9078 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9079 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009080 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009081
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009082 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9083 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9084 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009085 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009086 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009087 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009088
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009089 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9090 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9091 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9092 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9093
9094 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9095 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9096 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9097 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9098 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9099 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009101 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9102 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9103 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9104 they were received.
9105
9106 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9107 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9108 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9109 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9110 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9111
9112 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9113 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9114 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9115 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9116 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9117
9118 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9119 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9120 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9121
9122 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9123 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9124 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9125 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9126 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9127
9128 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9129 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9130 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9131 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9132 the client side.
9133
9134 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9135 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9136 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9137 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9138 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9139 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9140 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9141
9142 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9143 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9144 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9145 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9146 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9147 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009148 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009149
9150 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9151 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9152 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9153 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9154 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9155 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9156
9157 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009158 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009159 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9160 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9161
9162 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9163 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9164 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9165 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9166 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9167 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9168 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9169 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9170 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9171 recommended for better fairness.
9172
9173 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009174 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009175 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9176 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9177
9178 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9179 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9180 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9181 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9182 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9183 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9184 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9185 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9186 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9187 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009188
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009189 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9190 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009191 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9192 reference it.
9193
9194 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9195 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009196 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9197 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9198 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009199
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009200 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9201 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9202 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9203 something that can be ignored.
9204
9205 Example:
9206 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9207 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9208 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9209 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9210
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009211 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009212 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009213
9214
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009215stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009216 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9218 no | no | yes | yes
9219
9220 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009221 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009222 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009223 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009224 server is selected.
9225
9226 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9227 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9228 the "stick-table" statement.
9229
9230 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9231 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9232 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9233 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9234
9235 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9236 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9237 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9238 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9239 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9240 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009241 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009242 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9243 rules.
9244
9245 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9246 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9247 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9248 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9249 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9250 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9251 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9252
9253 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9254 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9255 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9256 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9257
9258 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9259 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9260 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9261 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9262 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9263 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009264 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9265 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9266 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9267 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9268 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9269 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9270 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9271 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9272 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009273
9274 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9275
9276 Example :
9277 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9278 backend https
9279 mode tcp
9280 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009281 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009282 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009283
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009284 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9285 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9286
9287 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9288 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9289 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9290
9291 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9292 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009293
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009294 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9295 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9296 # at offset 44.
9297
9298 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9299 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9300
9301 # Learn on response if server hello.
9302 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009303
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009304 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9305 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9306
9307 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9308 extraction.
9309
9310
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009311tcp-check connect [params*]
9312 Opens a new connection
9313 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9314 no | no | yes | yes
9315
9316 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9317 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9318 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9319
9320 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9321 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9322 of the sequence.
9323
9324 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9325 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9326 do.
9327
9328 Parameters :
9329 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9330 use the TCP connection.
9331
9332 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9333 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9334 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9335
9336 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9337
9338 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9339
9340 Examples:
9341 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9342 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9343 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9344 option tcp-check
9345 tcp-check connect
9346 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9347 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9348 tcp-check send \r\n
9349 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9350 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9351 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9352 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9353 tcp-check send \r\n
9354 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9355 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9356
9357 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9358 option tcp-check
9359 tcp-check connect port 110
9360 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9361 tcp-check connect port 143
9362 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9363 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9364
9365 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9366
9367
9368tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009369 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009370 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9371 no | no | yes | yes
9372
9373 Arguments :
9374 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9375 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9376 binary.
9377 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9378 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9379 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9380
9381 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9382 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9383 with the usual backslash ('\').
9384 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009385 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009386 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9387 used upper or lower case.
9388
9389
9390 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9391
9392 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9393 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9394 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9395 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9396 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9397 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9398 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9399 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9400
9401 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9402 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9403 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9404 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9405 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9406 expression.
9407
9408 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9409 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9410 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9411 this exact hexadecimal string.
9412 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9413
9414 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9415 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9416 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9417 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9418 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9419 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9420 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9421 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9422 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9423 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9424 the null character.
9425
9426 Examples :
9427 # perform a POP check
9428 option tcp-check
9429 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9430
9431 # perform an IMAP check
9432 option tcp-check
9433 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9434
9435 # look for the redis master server
9436 option tcp-check
9437 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009438 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009439 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9440 tcp-check expect string role:master
9441 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9442 tcp-check expect string +OK
9443
9444
9445 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9446 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9447
9448
9449tcp-check send <data>
9450 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9451 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9452 no | no | yes | yes
9453
9454 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9455 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9456
9457 Examples :
9458 # look for the redis master server
9459 option tcp-check
9460 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9461 tcp-check expect string role:master
9462
9463 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9464 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9465
9466
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009467tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9468 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009469 tcp health check
9470 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9471 no | no | yes | yes
9472
9473 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9474 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009475 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009476 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9477 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9478 hexadecimal string.
9479 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9480
9481 Examples :
9482 # redis check in binary
9483 option tcp-check
9484 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9485 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9486
9487
9488 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9489 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9490
9491
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009492tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9493 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9495 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009496 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009497 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9498 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009499
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009500 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009501
9502 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9503 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009504 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9505 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9506 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9507 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9508 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9509 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009510
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009511 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9512 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9513 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9514 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009515
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009516 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009517 - accept :
9518 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9519 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9520 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009521
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009522 - reject :
9523 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9524 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9525 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9526 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9527 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9528 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9529 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9530 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9531 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9532 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9533 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009534 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009535
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009536 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9537 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9538 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9539 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9540 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9541 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9542 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9543 hosts.
9544
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009545 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9546 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9547 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9548 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9549 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9550 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9551 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9552 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9553
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009554 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9555 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9556 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9557 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9558 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9559 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9560 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9561 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9562 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009563 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9564 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009565
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009566 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009567 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009568 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9569 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9570 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009571 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009572 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9573 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9574 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9575 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9576 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9577 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9578 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9579 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009580
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009581 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009582 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009583 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009584 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009585 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9586 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9587 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009588
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009589 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9590 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9591 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9592 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009593
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009594 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9595 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9596 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9597 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9598 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009599 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9600 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9601 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9602 layer7 information is extracted.
9603
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009604 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9605 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9606 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9607 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9608 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009609
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009610 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9611 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9612 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9613 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9614
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009615 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9616 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9617 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9618 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9619
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009620 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
9621 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
9622 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
9623 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
9624 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009625
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009626 - set-src <expr> :
9627 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9628 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9629 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009630 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009631
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009632 Arguments:
9633 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9634 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009635
9636 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009637 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9638
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009639 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9640 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009641
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009642 - set-src-port <expr> :
9643 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9644 expression.
9645
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009646 Arguments:
9647 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9648 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009649
9650 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009651 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9652
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009653 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9654 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9655 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009656
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009657 - set-dst <expr> :
9658 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9659 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9660 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9661 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9662 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9663
9664 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9665 followed by some converters.
9666
9667 Example:
9668
9669 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9670 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9671
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009672 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9673 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9674
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009675 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9676 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9677 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9678 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9679
9680
9681 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9682 followed by some converters.
9683
9684 Example:
9685
9686 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9687
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009688 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9689 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9690 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9691
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009692 - "silent-drop" :
9693 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009694 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009695 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9696 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9697 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9698 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9699 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009700 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9701 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009702 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9703 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009704 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009705 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9706 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9707 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9708 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9709
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009710 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9711 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9712 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009713
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009714 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9715 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9716 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009717
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009718 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009719 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009720 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009721
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009722 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9723 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9724 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009725
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009726 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009727 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9728 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009729
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009730 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9731
9732 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9733
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009734 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9735
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009736 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009737
9738
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009739tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9740 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009742 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009743 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009744 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9745 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009746
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009747 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009748
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009749 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009750 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9751 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9752 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9753 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009754
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009755 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9756 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9757 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9758 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009759 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9760 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9761 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9762 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9763 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9764 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009765 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009766 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009767
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009768 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9769 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9770 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9771 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009772
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009773 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009774 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009775 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009776 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9777 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009778 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009779 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009780 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009781 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01009782 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009783 - set-dst <expr>
9784 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009785 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009786 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009787 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009788 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01009789 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009790
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009791 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9792 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009793 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
9794 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009795
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009796 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9797 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9798 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9799 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9800 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9801 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009802
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009803 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009804 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9805 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009806
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009807 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009808 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9809 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9810 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9811 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009812 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9813 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9814 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009815
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009816 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009817 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9818 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9819 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009820
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009821 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
9822 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
9823
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009824 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009825 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9826 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009827
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009828 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9829 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009830 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009831 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9832 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009833 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009834 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009835 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009836 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9837 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009838 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009839 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9840 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009841
9842 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9843 followed by some converters.
9844
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009845 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9846 <var-name>.
9847
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009848 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9849 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9850 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9851 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9852 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9853
9854 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9855 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9856 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9857 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9858 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9859 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9860 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9861 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9862 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9863 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9864 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9865
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009866 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9867 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9868 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9869 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9870 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9871
9872 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9873
9874 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9875
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01009876 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
9877 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
9878 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
9879 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
9880 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
9881 evaluated.
9882
9883 Example:
9884 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
9885
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009886 Example:
9887
9888 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009889 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009890
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009891 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009892 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9893 # and reject everything else.
9894 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9895 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009896 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009897 tcp-request content reject
9898
9899 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009900 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9901 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9902 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009903 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009904
9905 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9906 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9907 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009908 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009909 tcp-request content reject
9910
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009911 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009912 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009913 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009914 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009915 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9916 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009917
9918 Example:
9919 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9920 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009921 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009922
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009923 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009924 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009925
9926 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009927 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009928 # protecting all our sites
9929 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009930 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9931 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009932 ...
9933 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9934
9935 backend http_dynamic
9936 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009937 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009938 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009939 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009940 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009941 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009942 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009943
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009944 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009945
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009946 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9947 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009948
9949
9950tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9951 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009953 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009954 Arguments :
9955 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9956 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9957 as explained at the top of this document.
9958
9959 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9960 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9961 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9962 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9963 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9964
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009965 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9966 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9967 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9968 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9969
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009970 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9971 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009972 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009973 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009974 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9975 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9976 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9977 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009978
9979 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9980 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9981 it pass through unaffected.
9982
9983 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9984 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9985 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009986 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009987 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9988 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009989 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9990 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9991 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009992
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009993 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009994 "timeout client".
9995
9996
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009997tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9998 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10000 no | no | yes | yes
10001 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010002 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10003 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010004
10005 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10006
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010007 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010008 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10009 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010010 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10011 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010012
10013 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10014
10015 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10016 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10017 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10018 inserted.
10019
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010020 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010021 - accept :
10022 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10023 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10024 the rules evaluation.
10025
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010026 - close :
10027 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10028 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10029 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10030 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10031 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10032 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010033 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010034 protocols.
10035
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010036 - reject :
10037 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10038 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010039 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010040
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010041 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10042 Sets a variable.
10043
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010044 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10045 Unsets a variable.
10046
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010047 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10048 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10049 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10050 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10051
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010052 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10053 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10054 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10055 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10056
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010057 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
10058 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10059 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10060 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10061 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010062
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010063 - "silent-drop" :
10064 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010065 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010066 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10067 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10068 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10069 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10070 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010071 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10072 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010073 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10074 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010075 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010076 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10077 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10078 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10079 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10080
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010081 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10082 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10083
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010084 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10085 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10086 for changing the default action to a reject.
10087
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010088 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10089 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10090 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10091 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010092 period.
10093
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010094 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10095 declared inline.
10096
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010097 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10098 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010099 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010100 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10101 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010102 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010103 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010104 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010105 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10106 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010107 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010108 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10109 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010110
10111 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10112 followed by some converters.
10113
10114 Example:
10115
10116 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10117
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010118 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10119 <var-name>.
10120
10121 Example:
10122
10123 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10124
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010125 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10126 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10127 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10128 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10129 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10130
10131 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10132
10133 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10134
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010135 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10136
10137 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10138
10139
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010140tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10141 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10143 no | yes | yes | no
10144 Arguments :
10145 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10146 below.
10147
10148 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10149
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010150 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010151 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10152 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10153 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10154 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10155 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10156 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10157 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010158 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010159 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10160 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10161 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10162 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10163 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10164 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10165 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10166 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10167 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10168 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10169 instead.
10170
10171 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10172 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10173 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10174 rules which may be inserted.
10175
10176 Several types of actions are supported :
10177 - accept : the request is accepted
10178 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10179 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10180 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010181 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010182 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010183 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010184 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010185 - silent-drop
10186
10187 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10188 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10189 sections for a complete description.
10190
10191 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10192 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10193 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10194
10195 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10196 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10197 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10198 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10199 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10200
10201 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10202 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10203
10204 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10205 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10206 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10207
10208 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10209 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10210 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10211
10212 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10213 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10214 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10215
10216 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10217 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10218 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10219
10220 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10221
10222 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10223
10224
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010225tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10226 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10228 no | no | yes | yes
10229 Arguments :
10230 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10231 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10232 as explained at the top of this document.
10233
10234 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10235
10236
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010237timeout check <timeout>
10238 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10239 established.
10240
10241 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10242 yes | no | yes | yes
10243 Arguments:
10244 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10245 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10246 as explained at the top of this document.
10247
10248 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10249 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010250 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010251 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010252 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10253 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10254 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010255
10256 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10257 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10258
10259 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10260 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010261 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010262
10263 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10264 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10265 forget about it.
10266
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010267 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10268 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010269
10270
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010271timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010272 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10274 yes | yes | yes | no
10275 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010276 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010277 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10278 as explained at the top of this document.
10279
10280 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10281 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10282 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010283 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10284 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10285 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10286 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010287 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10288 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10289 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010290 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010291 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010292 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10293 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010294 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10295 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010296
10297 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10298 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10299 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10300 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010301 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010302 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10303
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010304 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010305
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010306 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010307
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010308
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010309timeout client-fin <timeout>
10310 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10312 yes | yes | yes | no
10313 Arguments :
10314 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10315 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10316 as explained at the top of this document.
10317
10318 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10319 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10320 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10321 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10322 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10323 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10324 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010325 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10326 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10327 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010328
10329 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10330 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10331 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10332
10333 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10334
10335
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010336timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010337 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10339 yes | no | yes | yes
10340 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010341 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010342 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10343 as explained at the top of this document.
10344
10345 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010346 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010347 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010348 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010349 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10350 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010351
10352 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10353 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10354 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10355 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010356 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010357 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10358
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010359 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010360
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010361
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010362timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10363 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10365 yes | yes | yes | yes
10366 Arguments :
10367 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10368 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10369 as explained at the top of this document.
10370
10371 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10372 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10373 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10374 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10375 once the request has started to present itself.
10376
10377 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10378 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10379 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10380 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10381 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10382
10383 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10384 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10385 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10386 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10387
10388 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10389 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010390 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010391 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10392 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010393 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010394
10395 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10396 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10397 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10398 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10399
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010400 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10401 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010402 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10403
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010404 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10405
10406
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010407timeout http-request <timeout>
10408 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010410 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010411 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010412 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010413 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10414 as explained at the top of this document.
10415
10416 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10417 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10418 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10419 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10420 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10421 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10422 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010423 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10424 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10425 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10426 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010427 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010428 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10429 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010430
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010431 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10432 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10433 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10434 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10435 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010436 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010437
10438 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10439 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010440 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010441 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10442 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10443
10444 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010445 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10446 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10447 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010448
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010449 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010450 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010451
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010452
10453timeout queue <timeout>
10454 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10456 yes | no | yes | yes
10457 Arguments :
10458 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10459 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10460 as explained at the top of this document.
10461
10462 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10463 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10464 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10465 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10466 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10467
10468 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10469 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10470 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10471 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10472
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010473 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010474
10475
10476timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010477 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10479 yes | no | yes | yes
10480 Arguments :
10481 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10482 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10483 as explained at the top of this document.
10484
10485 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10486 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10487 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10488 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10489 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10490 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10491 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10492
10493 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10494 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10495 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10496 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10497 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010498 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010499 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010500 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10501 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010502 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10503 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010504
10505 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10506 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10507 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10508 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010509 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010510 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10511
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010512 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010513
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010514
10515timeout server-fin <timeout>
10516 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10518 yes | no | yes | yes
10519 Arguments :
10520 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10521 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10522 as explained at the top of this document.
10523
10524 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10525 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10526 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10527 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10528 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10529 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10530 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10531 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10532 situations, it should not be needed.
10533
10534 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10535 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10536 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10537
10538 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10539
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010540
10541timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010542 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10544 yes | yes | yes | yes
10545 Arguments :
10546 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10547 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10548 as explained at the top of this document.
10549
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010550 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
10551 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
10552 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010553
10554 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10555 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10556 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10557 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010558 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010559
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020010560 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010561
10562
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010563timeout tunnel <timeout>
10564 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10566 yes | no | yes | yes
10567 Arguments :
10568 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10569 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10570 as explained at the top of this document.
10571
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010572 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010573 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10574 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10575 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010576 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10577 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010578 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10579 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10580 specified.
10581
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010582 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10583 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10584 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10585 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10586 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10587 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10588 state.
10589
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010590 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10591 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10592 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10593 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010594 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010595
10596 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10597 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10598 forget about it.
10599
10600 Example :
10601 defaults http
10602 option http-server-close
10603 timeout connect 5s
10604 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010605 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010606 timeout server 30s
10607 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10608
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010609 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010610
10611
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010612transparent (deprecated)
10613 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010615 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010616 Arguments : none
10617
10618 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10619 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10620 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10621 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10622 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10623 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10624 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10625 appropriate server.
10626
10627 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10628
10629 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10630 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10631
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010632 See also: "option transparent"
10633
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010634unique-id-format <string>
10635 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10637 yes | yes | yes | no
10638 Arguments :
10639 <string> is a log-format string.
10640
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010641 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10642 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10643 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10644 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010645
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010646 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10647 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10648 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10649 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10650 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10651 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10652 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10653 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010654
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010655 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10656 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010657
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010658 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010659
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010660 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010661
10662 will generate:
10663
10664 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10665
10666 See also: "unique-id-header"
10667
10668unique-id-header <name>
10669 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10671 yes | yes | yes | no
10672 Arguments :
10673 <name> is the name of the header.
10674
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010675 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10676 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010677
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010678 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010679
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010680 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010681 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10682
10683 will generate:
10684
10685 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10686
10687 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010688
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010689use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010690 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10692 no | yes | yes | no
10693 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010694 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10695 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010696
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010697 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10698 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010699
10700 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10701 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10702 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010703 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010704 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010705 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10706 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010707
10708 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10709 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10710 assign the backend.
10711
10712 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10713 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10714 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10715 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10716 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10717 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10718
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010719 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010720 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010721 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10722 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10723 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10724
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010725 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10726 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10727 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10728 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10729 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10730 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10731 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10732 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10733 cannot be forced from the request.
10734
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010735 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010736 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10737 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10738
10739 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10740 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010741
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020010742use-fcgi-app <name>
10743 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
10744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10745 no | no | yes | yes
10746 Arguments :
10747 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
10748
10749 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010750
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010751use-server <server> if <condition>
10752use-server <server> unless <condition>
10753 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10755 no | no | yes | yes
10756 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010757 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010758
10759 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10760
10761 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10762 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10763 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10764
10765 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10766 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10767 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10768 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10769 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10770 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10771 matches will assign the server.
10772
10773 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10774 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10775 with the next rules until one matches.
10776
10777 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10778 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10779 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10780 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10781
10782 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10783 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10784 stripped.
10785
10786 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10787 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10788 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10789 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10790
10791 Example :
10792 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10793 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10794 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10795 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10796 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10797 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010798 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010799 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10800 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10801
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010802 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010803
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010804
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100108055. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010806--------------------------
10807
10808The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10809depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10810settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10811written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10812described in this section.
10813
10814
108155.1. Bind options
10816-----------------
10817
10818The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10819as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10820no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10821parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10822while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10823provided immediately after the setting name.
10824
10825The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10826
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010827accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10828 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10829 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10830 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10831 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10832 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10833 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10834 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10835 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10836 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010837 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10838 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10839 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010840
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010841accept-proxy
10842 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010843 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10844 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010845 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10846 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10847 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10848 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010849 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010850 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10851 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010852 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10853 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010854
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010855allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010856 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010857 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010858 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010859 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10860 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010861
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010862alpn <protocols>
10863 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10864 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10865 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010866 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010867 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010868 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10869 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10870 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10871 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10872 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10873 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10874 preference, like below :
10875
10876 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010877
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010878backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010879 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010880 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10881
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010882curves <curves>
10883 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10884 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10885 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10886 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10887 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10888 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10889
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010890ecdhe <named curve>
10891 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010892 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10893 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010894
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010895ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010896 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10897 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10898 client's certificate.
10899
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010900ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10901 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10902 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10903 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10904 error is ignored.
10905
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010906ca-sign-file <cafile>
10907 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10908 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10909 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10910 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10911 'generate-certificates' for details.
10912
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010913ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010914 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10915 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10916 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10917 'generate-certificates' for details.
10918
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010919ciphers <ciphers>
10920 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10921 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010922 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010923 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010924 information and recommendations see e.g.
10925 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10926 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10927 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10928
10929ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10930 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10931 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10932 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10933 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010934 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10935 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010936
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010937crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010938 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10939 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10940 to verify client's certificate.
10941
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010942crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010943 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10944 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10945 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10946 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10947 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10948 file.
10949
10950 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10951 are loaded.
10952
10953 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010954 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010955 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10956 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10957 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10958 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010959 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10960 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010961 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010962
10963 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10964 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10965 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10966 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010967 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10968 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010969
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010970 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010971
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010972 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010973 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010974 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10975 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010976 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10977 clients).
10978
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010979 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10980 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10981 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10982 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10983 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10984 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10985 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10986 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10987 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10988 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10989 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10990 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10991 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10992
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010993 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10994 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10995 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10996 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10997 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10998
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010999 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11000 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11001 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11002 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011003
11004 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11005 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11006 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11007 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11008 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11009 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11010 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11011 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11012 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11013
11014 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11015
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011016 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011017 a cert bundle.
11018
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011019 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011020 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11021 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11022 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11023 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11024 provide multi-cert support.
11025
11026 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11027
11028 Filename | CN | SAN
11029 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11030 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011031 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011032 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11033 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11034
11035 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11036 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11037 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11038 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011039 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11040 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11041 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011042
11043 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11044 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11045
11046 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11047 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11048 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11049
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011050crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011051 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011052 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011053 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011054 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011055
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011056crt-list <file>
11057 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011058 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11059 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011060
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011061 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11062
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011063 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11064 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011065 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011066 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011067
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011068 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11069 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11070 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11071 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11072 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11073 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11074 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11075 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011076
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011077 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011078 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011079 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11080 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11081 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011082
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011083 crt-list file example:
11084 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011085 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011086 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011087 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011088
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011089defer-accept
11090 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11091 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11092 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011093 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011094 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11095 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11096 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11097 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11098 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11099 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11100 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11101
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011102expose-fd listeners
11103 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11104 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011105 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11106 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011107 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011108
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011109force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011110 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011111 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011112 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011113 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011114
11115force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011116 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011117 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011118 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011119
11120force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011121 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011122 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011123 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011124
11125force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011126 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011127 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011128 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011129
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011130force-tlsv13
11131 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11132 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011133 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011134
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011135generate-certificates
11136 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11137 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11138 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11139 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11140 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11141 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11142 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11143 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11144 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11145 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11146 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11147
11148 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11149 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011150 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011151 certificate is used many times.
11152
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011153gid <gid>
11154 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11155 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11156 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11157 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11158 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11159
11160group <group>
11161 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11162 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11163 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11164 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11165 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11166
11167id <id>
11168 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11169 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11170 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11171 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11172
11173interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011174 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11175 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11176 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11177 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11178 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11179 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011180 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11181 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11182 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11183 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11184 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11185 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011186
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011187level <level>
11188 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11189 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11190 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011191 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011192 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11193 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11194 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011195 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011196 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011197 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011198 all counters).
11199
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011200severity-output <format>
11201 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11202 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11203 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11204 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11205 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11206 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11207 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11208 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11209 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11210 rfc5424 convention.
11211
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011212maxconn <maxconn>
11213 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11214 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11215 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11216 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11217 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11218 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11219 eat all memory.
11220
11221mode <mode>
11222 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11223 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11224 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11225 UNIX sockets.
11226
11227mss <maxseg>
11228 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11229 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11230 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11231 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11232 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11233 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11234 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11235 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11236 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11237 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11238 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11239
11240name <name>
11241 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11242 page.
11243
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011244namespace <name>
11245 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11246 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11247 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11248 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11249
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011250nice <nice>
11251 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11252 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11253 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11254 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11255 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11256 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11257 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11258 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11259 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11260 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11261 one for an RDP socket.
11262
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011263no-ca-names
11264 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11265 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11266
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011267no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011268 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011269 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011270 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011271 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011272 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11273 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011274
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011275no-tls-tickets
11276 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11277 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11278 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011279 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11280 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011281
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011282no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011283 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011284 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011285 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011286 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011287 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11288 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011289
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011290no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011291 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011292 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011293 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011294 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011295 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11296 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011297
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011298no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011299 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011300 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011301 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011302 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011303 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11304 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011305
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011306no-tlsv13
11307 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11308 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11309 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11310 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011311 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11312 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011313
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011314npn <protocols>
11315 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11316 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11317 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011318 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011319 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011320 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11321 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11322 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11323 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11324 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011325
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011326prefer-client-ciphers
11327 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11328 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11329 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011330 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11331 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11332 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011333
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011334process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011335 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011336 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011337 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011338 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11339 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11340 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11341 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011342 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011343 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11344 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11345 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11346 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11347 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011348
11349 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11350
11351 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11352 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11353 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11354 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11355 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11356 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11357 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11358 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011359
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011360proto <name>
11361 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11362 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11363 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11364 in haproxy -vv.
11365 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11366 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011367 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011368 h2" on the bind line.
11369
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011370ssl
11371 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011372 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011373 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11374 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011375 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11376 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011377
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011378ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11379 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11380 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11381 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11382
11383ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11384 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11385 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11386 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11387
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011388strict-sni
11389 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11390 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11391 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11392 See the "crt" option for more information.
11393
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011394tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011395 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011396 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11397 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011398 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011399 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11400 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11401 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11402 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11403 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11404 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11405 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11406
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011407tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011408 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011409 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11410 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11411 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11412 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11413 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11414 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11415 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011416 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11417 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11418 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011419
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011420tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11421 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011422 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11423 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11424 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11425 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11426 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11427 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11428 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11429 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11430 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11431 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011432 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11433 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11434
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011435transparent
11436 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11437 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11438 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11439 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11440 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11441 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11442 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11443 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11444 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11445 so check for support with your vendor.
11446
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011447v4v6
11448 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11449 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11450 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11451 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011452 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011453
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011454v6only
11455 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11456 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11457 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011458 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11459 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011460
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011461uid <uid>
11462 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11463 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11464 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11465 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11466 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11467
11468user <user>
11469 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11470 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11471 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11472 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11473 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11474
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011475verify [none|optional|required]
11476 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11477 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11478 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11479 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11480 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011481 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11482 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11483 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11484 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011485
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200114865.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011487------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011488
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011489The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11490which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11491arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11492settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11493after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11494Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11495address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011496
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011497 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011498 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011499
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011500Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11501keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11502
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011503The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011504
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011505addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011506 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011507 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11508 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11509 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11510 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11511 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011512
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011513agent-check
11514 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011515 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011516 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11517 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11518 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011519
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011520 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011521 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011522 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11523 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11524 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011525
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011526 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11527 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11528 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11529 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11530 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011531
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011532 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011533 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011534
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011535 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11536 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11537 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011538
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011539 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11540 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11541 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011542
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011543 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11544 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11545 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11546 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11547 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011548 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011549 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011550
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011551 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11552 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011553
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011554 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11555 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11556 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11557 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11558 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11559 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11560 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11561 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11562 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011563
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011564 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11565 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011566 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11567 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11568 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011569 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011570
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011571 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011572 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011573
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011574agent-send <string>
11575 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11576 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11577 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11578 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11579 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11580
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011581agent-inter <delay>
11582 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11583 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11584
11585 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11586 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11587 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11588 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11589 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11590 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11591 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11592 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11593 of backends use the same servers.
11594
11595 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11596
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011597agent-addr <addr>
11598 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11599
11600 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11601 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11602 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11603 hostname, it will be resolved.
11604
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011605agent-port <port>
11606 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11607
11608 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11609
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011610allow-0rtt
11611 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011612 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11613 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011614
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011615alpn <protocols>
11616 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11617 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11618 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011619 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011620 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11621 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11622 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11623 now obsolete NPN extension.
11624 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11625 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11626
11627 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11628
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011629backup
11630 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11631 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11632 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11633 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011634 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11635 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011636
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011637ca-file <cafile>
11638 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11639 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11640 server's certificate.
11641
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011642check
11643 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011644 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11645 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11646 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11647 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11648 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11649 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11650 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011651 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11652 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011653 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11654 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011655
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011656check-send-proxy
11657 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11658 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11659 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11660 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11661 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11662 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11663 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11664
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011665check-alpn <protocols>
11666 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11667 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11668 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11669
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011670check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011671 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011672 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11673 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011674
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011675check-ssl
11676 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11677 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11678 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11679 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011680 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011681 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11682 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011683 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011684 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11685 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011686
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011687check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011688 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011689 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
11690 for normal traffic.
11691
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011692ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011693 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11694 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11695 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011696 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11697 information and recommendations see e.g.
11698 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11699 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11700 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011701
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011702ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11703 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11704 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11705 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11706 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011707 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11708 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11709 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011710
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011711cookie <value>
11712 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11713 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11714 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11715 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11716 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11717 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11718 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11719
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011720crl-file <crlfile>
11721 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11722 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11723 to verify server's certificate.
11724
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011725crt <cert>
11726 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11727 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11728 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11729 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11730 certificate request.
11731
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011732disabled
11733 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11734 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11735 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11736 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11737 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011738 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011739
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011740enabled
11741 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11742 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11743 default value.
11744 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11745 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011746
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011747error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011748 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11749 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11750 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011751
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011752 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011753
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011754fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011755 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11756 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11757 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11758
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011759force-sslv3
11760 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11761 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011762 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011763 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011764
11765force-tlsv10
11766 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011767 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011768 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011769
11770force-tlsv11
11771 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011772 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011773 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011774
11775force-tlsv12
11776 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011777 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011778 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011779
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011780force-tlsv13
11781 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11782 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011783 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011784
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011785id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011786 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11787 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11788 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011789
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011790init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11791 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11792 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011793 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011794 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11795 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11796 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11797 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11798 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11799 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11800 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11801 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11802 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011803 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011804 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11805 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11806 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11807 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11808 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11809 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011810 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011811
11812 Example:
11813 defaults
11814 # never fail on address resolution
11815 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11816
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011817inter <delay>
11818fastinter <delay>
11819downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011820 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11821 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11822 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11823 between checks depending on the server state :
11824
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011825 Server state | Interval used
11826 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11827 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11828 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11829 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11830 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11831 or yet unchecked. |
11832 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11833 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11834 | "inter" otherwise.
11835 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011836
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011837 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11838 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11839 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11840 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011841 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11842 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11843 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11844 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11845 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011846
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011847maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011848 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11849 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010011850 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
11851 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011852 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11853 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11854 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11855 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11856
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010011857 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
11858 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
11859 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
11860 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
11861 than 50 concurrent requests.
11862
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011863maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011864 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11865 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11866 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11867 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11868 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11869 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11870 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11871
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011872max-reuse <count>
11873 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11874 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11875 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11876 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11877 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11878 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11879 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11880 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11881
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011882minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011883 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11884 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11885 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11886 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11887 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11888 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011889 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011890 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011891
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011892namespace <name>
11893 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11894 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11895 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11896 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11897
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011898no-agent-check
11899 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11900 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11901 default value.
11902 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11903 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11904
11905no-backup
11906 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11907 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11908 default value.
11909 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11910 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11911
11912no-check
11913 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11914 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11915 default value.
11916 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11917 "default-server" "check" setting.
11918
11919no-check-ssl
11920 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11921 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11922 default value.
11923 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11924 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11925
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011926no-send-proxy
11927 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11928 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11929 default value.
11930 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11931 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11932
11933no-send-proxy-v2
11934 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11935 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11936 default value.
11937 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11938 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11939
11940no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11941 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11942 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11943 default value.
11944 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11945 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11946
11947no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11948 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11949 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11950 default value.
11951 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11952 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11953
11954no-ssl
11955 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11956 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11957 default value.
11958 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11959 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11960
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011961no-ssl-reuse
11962 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11963 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11964 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11965 and for paranoid users.
11966
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011967no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011968 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11969 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011970 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011971
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011972 Supported in default-server: No
11973
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011974no-tls-tickets
11975 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11976 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11977 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011978 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11979 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011980 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011981
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011982no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011983 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011984 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11985 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011986 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11987 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011988 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011989
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011990 Supported in default-server: No
11991
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011992no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011993 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011994 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11995 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011996 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11997 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011998 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011999
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012000 Supported in default-server: No
12001
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012002no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012003 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012004 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12005 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012006 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12007 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012008 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012009
12010 Supported in default-server: No
12011
12012no-tlsv13
12013 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12014 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12015 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12016 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12017 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012018 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012019
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012020 Supported in default-server: No
12021
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012022no-verifyhost
12023 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12024 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12025 default value.
12026 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12027 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012028
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012029no-tfo
12030 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12031 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12032 default value.
12033 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12034 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12035
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012036non-stick
12037 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12038 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12039 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12040
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012041npn <protocols>
12042 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12043 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12044 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012045 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012046 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12047 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12048 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12049
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012050observe <mode>
12051 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12052 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12053 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12054 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12055 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12056 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012057 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012058
12059 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12060
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012061on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012062 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12063 Currently, four modes are available:
12064 - fastinter: force fastinter
12065 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12066 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12067 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12068 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12069
12070 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12071
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012072on-marked-down <action>
12073 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12074 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012075 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12076 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12077 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12078 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12079 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12080 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12081 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12082 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012083
12084 Actions are disabled by default
12085
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012086on-marked-up <action>
12087 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12088 Currently one action is available:
12089 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12090 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12091 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12092 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012093 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12094 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012095 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12096 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12097
12098 Actions are disabled by default
12099
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012100pool-max-conn <max>
12101 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12102 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12103 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12104 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12105 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12106 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12107
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012108pool-purge-delay <delay>
12109 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012110 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012111 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012112
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012113port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012114 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12115 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12116 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12117 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12118 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12119 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12120
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012121proto <name>
12122
12123 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12124 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12125 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12126 reported in haproxy -vv.
12127 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12128 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012130redir <prefix>
12131 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12132 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12133 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12134 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12135 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12136 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12137 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12138 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012139 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012140 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012141 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12142 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12143 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12144 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12145
12146 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12147
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012148rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012149 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12150 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12151 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12152
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012153resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12154 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12155 server.
12156
12157 Available options:
12158
12159 * allow-dup-ip
12160 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12161 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12162 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12163 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12164 For such case, simply enable this option.
12165 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12166
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050012167 * ignore-weight
12168 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
12169 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
12170 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
12171
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012172 * prevent-dup-ip
12173 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12174 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12175 same fqdn.
12176 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12177
12178 Example:
12179 backend b_myapp
12180 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12181 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12182 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12183
12184 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12185 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12186 it
12187 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12188 different address
12189
12190 Default value: not set
12191
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012192resolve-prefer <family>
12193 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12194 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12195 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12196 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12197
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012198 Default value: ipv6
12199
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012200 Example:
12201
12202 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012203
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012204resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012205 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012206 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012207 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012208 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12209 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012210 configured network, another address is selected.
12211
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012212 Example:
12213
12214 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012215
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012216resolvers <id>
12217 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12218 hostname.
12219
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012220 Example:
12221
12222 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012223
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012224 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012225
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012226send-proxy
12227 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12228 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12229 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12230 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012231 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12232 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12233 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12234 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12235 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12236 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12237 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12238 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12239 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12240 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012241 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12242 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012243
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012244send-proxy-v2
12245 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12246 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12247 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12248 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012249 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12250 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12251 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12252 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012253
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012254proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12255 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12256 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012257 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12258 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012259 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12260 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012261 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012262
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012263send-proxy-v2-ssl
12264 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12265 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12266 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12267 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12268 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12269 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12270 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012271 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12272 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012273
12274send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12275 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12276 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12277 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12278 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12279 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12280 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12281 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12282 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012283 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12284 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012285
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012286slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012287 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12288 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12289 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12290 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12291 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12292 parameters :
12293
12294 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12295 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12296
12297 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12298 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12299 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12300 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12301
12302 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12303 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12304 seen as failed.
12305
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012306sni <expression>
12307 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12308 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12309 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12310 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012311 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12312 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012313 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012314 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12315 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012316
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012317source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012318source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012319source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012320 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12321 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12322 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12323 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12324
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012325 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12326 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12327 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12328 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12329 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12330 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12331 server.
12332
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012333 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12334 specifying the source address without port(s).
12335
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012336ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012337 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12338 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12339 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12340 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12341 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12342 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012343 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12344 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012345
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012346ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12347 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12348 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12349 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12350
12351ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12352 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12353 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12354 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12355
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012356ssl-reuse
12357 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12358 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12359 default value.
12360 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12361 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12362
12363stick
12364 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12365 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12366 default value.
12367 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12368 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012369
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012370socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012371 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012372 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12373 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12374
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012375tcp-ut <delay>
12376 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12377 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12378 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012379 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012380 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12381 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12382 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12383 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12384 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12385 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12386 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12387 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12388 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12389
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012390tfo
12391 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12392 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12393 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12394 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12395 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012396 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012397
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012398track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012399 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12400 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12401 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12402 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012403 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12404
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012405tls-tickets
12406 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12407 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12408 default value.
12409 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12410 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012411
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012412verify [none|required]
12413 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012414 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012415 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12416 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012417 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012418 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12419 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12420 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12421 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12422 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12423 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12424 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12425 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012426
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012427verifyhost <hostname>
12428 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012429 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12430 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12431 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12432 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12433 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12434 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12435 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12436 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012437
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012438weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012439 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12440 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12441 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012442 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12443 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12444 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12445 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12446 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12447 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012448
12449
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124505.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12451-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012452
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012453HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12454using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12455configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012456This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12457can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12458workload.
12459This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12460resolution at run time.
12461Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12462carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12463
12464
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124655.3.1. Global overview
12466----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012467
12468As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12469different steps of the process life:
12470
12471 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12472 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12473 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12474
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012475 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12476 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012477
12478A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12479 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12480 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12481 resolution to know this new IP.
12482
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012483When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012484HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012485SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12486from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12487will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12488will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012489
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012490A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012491 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012492 first valid response.
12493
12494 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12495 servers return an error.
12496
12497
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124985.3.2. The resolvers section
12499----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012500
12501This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012502HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12503contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012504
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012505When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12506uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12507is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12508answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12509
12510When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012511used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012512
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012513 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12514 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12515 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012516
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012517 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12518 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012519
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012520 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12521 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12522 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012523
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012524For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12525following scenarios are possible:
12526
12527 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12528 ignored
12529
12530 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12531 applied
12532
12533 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12534 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12535
12536 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12537 retries the query with a new type
12538
12539 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12540 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012541
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012542As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12543a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012544<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012545
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012546
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012547resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012548 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012549
12550A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12551
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012552accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012553 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012554 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012555 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12556 by RFC 6891)
12557
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012558 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12559
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012560nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12561 DNS server description:
12562 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12563 <ip> : IP address of the server
12564 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12565
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012566parse-resolv-conf
12567 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12568 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12569 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12570
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012571hold <status> <period>
12572 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12573 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012574 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012575 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012576 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12577 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12578 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12579
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012580 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012581
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012582resolve_retries <nb>
12583 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12584 giving up.
12585 Default value: 3
12586
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012587 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12588 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12589 type.
12590
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012591timeout <event> <time>
12592 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12593 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12594 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012595 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12596 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012597 Default value: 1s
12598 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012599 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012600 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012601 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12602 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12603
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012604 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012605
12606 resolvers mydns
12607 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12608 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012609 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012610 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012611 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012612 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012613 hold other 30s
12614 hold refused 30s
12615 hold nx 30s
12616 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012617 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012618 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012619
12620
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200126216. Cache
12622---------
12623
12624HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
12625(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
12626RAM.
12627
12628The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
12629this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
12630
12631If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
12632independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
12633when we try to allocate a new one.
12634
12635The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
12636
12637It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
12638"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
12639for more details.
12640
12641When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
12642replaced by "<CACHE>".
12643
12644
126456.1. Limitation
12646----------------
12647
12648The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
12649
12650- If the response is not a 200
12651- If the response contains a Vary header
12652- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
12653- If the response is not cacheable
12654
12655- If the request is not a GET
12656- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
12657- If the request contains an Authorization header
12658
12659
126606.2. Setup
12661-----------
12662
12663To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
12664the corresponding http-request and response actions.
12665
12666
126676.2.1. Cache section
12668---------------------
12669
12670cache <name>
12671 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
12672 size of cache is mandatory.
12673
12674total-max-size <megabytes>
12675 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
12676 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
12677
12678max-object-size <bytes>
12679 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
12680 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
12681 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
12682
12683max-age <seconds>
12684 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
12685 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
12686 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
12687 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
12688 default.
12689
12690
126916.2.2. Proxy section
12692---------------------
12693
12694http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12695 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
12696 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
12697 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
12698 after this one.
12699
12700http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12701 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
12702 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
12703 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
12704 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
12705
12706
12707Example:
12708
12709 backend bck1
12710 mode http
12711
12712 http-request cache-use foobar
12713 http-response cache-store foobar
12714 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
12715
12716 cache foobar
12717 total-max-size 4
12718 max-age 240
12719
12720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200127217. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12722----------------------------------
12723
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012724HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012725client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12726The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12727these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12728but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12729data called patterns.
12730
12731
127327.1. ACL basics
12733---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012734
12735The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12736content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12737from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12738simple :
12739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012740 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012741 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012742 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12743 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012745The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12746adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012747
12748In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012750 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012751
12752This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12753Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12754and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012755an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12756conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12757as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12758are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012759
12760ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12761'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12762which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12763
12764There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12765performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012767The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12768specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12769this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012770methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12771ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012772
12773Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12774 - boolean
12775 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12776 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12777 - string
12778 - data block
12779
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012780Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12781converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12782would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12783The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12784which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12785
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012786Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12787keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12788fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12789which are summarized in the table below :
12790
12791 +---------------------+-----------------+
12792 | Sample or converter | Default |
12793 | output type | matching method |
12794 +---------------------+-----------------+
12795 | boolean | bool |
12796 +---------------------+-----------------+
12797 | integer | int |
12798 +---------------------+-----------------+
12799 | ip | ip |
12800 +---------------------+-----------------+
12801 | string | str |
12802 +---------------------+-----------------+
12803 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12804 +---------------------+-----------------+
12805
12806Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12807matching method, see below.
12808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012809The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12810 - boolean
12811 - integer or integer range
12812 - IP address / network
12813 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12814 - regular expression
12815 - hex block
12816
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012817The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12818
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012819 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12820 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012821 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012822 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012823 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012824 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012825 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012827The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12828read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12829if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12830lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12831will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12832beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12833a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12834lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12835exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12836
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012837The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12838parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12839ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12840a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12841check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12842
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012843The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12844socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12845file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012847Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12848loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12849
12850 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12851
12852In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12853the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12854case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12855as well.
12856
12857The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12858sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12859do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12860methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12861is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012862obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012863followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12864default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12865that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12866string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12867
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012868The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12869By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12870string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12871resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12872server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012873waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012874flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12875function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012877There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12878sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12879be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012880
12881 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12882 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012883 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12884 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12885 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12886 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012887
12888 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12889 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012890 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012891
12892 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012893 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012894
12895 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012896 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012897
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012898 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012899 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12900
12901 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12902 binary or string samples.
12903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012904 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12905 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012907 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12908 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12909 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012911 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12912 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012914 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12915 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012917 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12918 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012920 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12921 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012922 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012924 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12925 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12926 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012927
12928For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12929request, it is possible to do :
12930
12931 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12932
12933In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12934buffer, one would use the following acl :
12935
12936 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12937
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012938On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12939possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12940
12941 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012943All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12944criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12945method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12946to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12947criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12948the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012950If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012951the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12952For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012954 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12955 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12956 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12957 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012958
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012959
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012960The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12961types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12962combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12963brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12964default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012966 +-------------------------------------------------+
12967 | Input sample type |
12968 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012969 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012970 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12971 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12972 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012973 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012974 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012975 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012976 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012977 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012978 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012979 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012980 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012981 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012982 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012983 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012984 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012985 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012986 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012987 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012988 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012989 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012990 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012991 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012992 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012993 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012994 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12995 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12996 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012997
12998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129997.1.1. Matching booleans
13000------------------------
13001
13002In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13003Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13004When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13005that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13006
13007Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13008return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13009"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13010
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130127.1.2. Matching integers
13013------------------------
13014
13015Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13016enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13017to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13018
13019Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13020matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13021lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013022
13023For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13024unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13025representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13026
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013027As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13028two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13029instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13030ranges and operators.
13031
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013032For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013033operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13034Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13035of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013036
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013037Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013038
13039 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13040 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13041 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13042 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13043 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13044
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013045For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013046
13047 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13048
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013049This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13050
13051 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13052
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130547.1.3. Matching strings
13055-----------------------
13056
13057String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13058different forms :
13059
13060 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013061 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013062
13063 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013064 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013065
13066 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13067 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13068
13069 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13070 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13071
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013072 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013073 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13074 matches.
13075
13076 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13077 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13078 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013079
13080String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13081exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13082characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13083string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13084to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013085before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013086
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013087Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13088(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13089Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13090
13091Example:
13092 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13093 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13094
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130967.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13097---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013098
13099Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13100they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13101possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13102passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13103the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013104the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13105match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013106
13107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131087.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13109-------------------------------------
13110
13111It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13112not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13113a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13114to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13115digits may be used upper or lower case.
13116
13117Example :
13118 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13119 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13120
13121
131227.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13123---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013124
13125IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13126netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13127within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013128host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013129difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13130at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13131does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13132parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013133
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013134The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13135abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13136
13137 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13138 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13139 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13140 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13141 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13142 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13143 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13144 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13145
13146Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13147192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13148
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013149IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13150Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13151trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13152IPv6 patterns.
13153
13154HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13155following situations :
13156 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13157 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13158 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13159 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13160 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13161 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13162 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13163 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13164 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13165 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013167
131687.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13169----------------------------------
13170
13171Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13172combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13173
13174 - AND (implicit)
13175 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13176 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013178A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013180 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013182Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13183indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013185For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13186"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13187requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13188is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13189
13190 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013191 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13192 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13193 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013194
13195To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13196and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13197
13198 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13199 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13200 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13201 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13202
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013203 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013204 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13205 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13206 use_backend www if host_www
13207
13208It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13209expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13210be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13211the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13212
13213 The following rule :
13214
13215 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013216 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013217
13218 Can also be written that way :
13219
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013220 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013221
13222It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13223to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13224simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13225sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13226good use is the following :
13227
13228 With named ACLs :
13229
13230 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13231 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13232 monitor fail if site_dead
13233
13234 With anonymous ACLs :
13235
13236 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13237
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013238See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13239keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013240
13241
132427.3. Fetching samples
13243---------------------
13244
13245Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13246against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13247sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13248ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13249of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13250available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13251
13252This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13253Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13254compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13255deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13256
13257The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13258matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13259method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13260indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13261
13262As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13263when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13264mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13265the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13266ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13267
13268Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13269multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13270when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013271incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13272are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013273is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13274all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13275
13276Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13277 - name
13278 - name(arg1)
13279 - name(arg1,arg2)
13280
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013281
132827.3.1. Converters
13283-----------------
13284
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013285Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13286of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13287is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13288was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013289has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013290unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13291
13292These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13293sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13294the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013295support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013296
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013297A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13298support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13299supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13300(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13301bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013303The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013304
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001330551d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13306 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13307 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13308 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13309 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13310 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13311
13312 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013313 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13314 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013315 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13316 frontend http-in
13317 bind *:8081
13318 default_backend servers
13319 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13320 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13321
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013322add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013323 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013324 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013325 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13326 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013327 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013328 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13329 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13330 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13331 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013332 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013333 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013334
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013335aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13336 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13337 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13338 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13339 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13340 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13341 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13342
13343 Example:
13344 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13345 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13346
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013347and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013348 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013349 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013350 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13351 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013352 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013353 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13354 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13355 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13356 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013357 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013358 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013359
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013360b64dec
13361 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13362 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13363
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013364base64
13365 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013366 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013367 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13368
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013369bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013370 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013371 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013372 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013373 presence of a flag).
13374
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013375bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13376 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13377 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013378 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013379
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013380concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13381 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13382 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13383 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13384 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13385 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13386 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13387 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13388 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13389 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13390 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013391 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013392 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013393 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013394
13395 Example:
13396 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13397 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13398 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13399 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13400
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013401cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013402 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13403 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013404
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013405crc32([<avalanche>])
13406 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13407 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13408 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13409 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13410 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13411 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13412 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13413 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13414 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13415 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013416 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13417
13418crc32c([<avalanche>])
13419 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13420 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13421 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13422 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13423 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13424 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13425 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13426 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013427
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013428da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013429 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13430 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13431 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13432 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013433 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013434 configuration language.
13435
13436 Example:
13437 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013438 bind *:8881
13439 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013440 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013441
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010013442debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
13443 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
13444 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
13445 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
13446 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
13447 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
13448 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
13449 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
13450 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
13451 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
13452 printable sample types.
13453
13454 Example:
13455 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013456
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013457div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013458 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13459 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013460 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013461 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13462 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013463 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013464 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13465 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13466 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13467 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013468 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013469 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013470
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013471djb2([<avalanche>])
13472 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13473 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13474 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13475 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13476 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13477 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13478 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013479 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13480 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013481
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013482even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013483 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013484 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13485
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013486field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13487 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13488 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13489 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13490 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13491 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13492 fields.
13493
13494 Example :
13495 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13496 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13497 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13498 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13499 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013500
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013501hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013502 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013503 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013504 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013505 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013506
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013507hex2i
13508 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013509 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013510
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010013511http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013512 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13513 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000013514 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
13515 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
13516 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
13517 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
13518 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
13519 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
13520 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
13521 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013522
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013523in_table(<table>)
13524 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13525 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13526 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013527 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013528 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13529
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013530ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13531 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013532 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013533 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13534 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13535 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13536 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13537 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013538
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013539json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013540 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013541 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013542 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013543 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13544 of errors:
13545 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13546 bytes, ...)
13547 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13548 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13549
13550 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13551 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13552 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13553 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13554 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13555 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013556 - "ascii" : never fails;
13557 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13558 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013559 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013560 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013561 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13562 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13563
13564 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013565 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013566
13567 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013568 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013569 capture request header user-agent len 150
13570 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013571
13572 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13573 GET / HTTP/1.0
13574 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13575
13576 Output log:
13577 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13578
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013579language(<value>[,<default>])
13580 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13581 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13582 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13583 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13584 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13585 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13586 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13587 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13588 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013589 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013590 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13591 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013592
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013593 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013594
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013595 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13596 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013597
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013598 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13599 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13600 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13601 use_backend spanish if es
13602 use_backend french if fr
13603 use_backend english if en
13604 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013605
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013606length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013607 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13608 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13609 type. The result is of type integer.
13610
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013611lower
13612 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13613 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13614 type. The result is of type string.
13615
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013616ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13617 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13618 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13619 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13620 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13621 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13622 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13623
13624 Example :
13625
13626 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013627 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013628 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13629
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013630map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13631map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13632map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13633 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13634 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13635 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13636 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13637 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13638 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13639 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13640 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013641
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013642 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13643 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13644 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013645
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013646 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013647 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013648
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013649 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13650 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13651 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13652 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013653 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13654 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013655 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13656 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13657 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13658 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13659 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13660 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13661 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13662 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013663 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13664 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13665 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013666 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13667 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13668 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13669 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13670 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013671
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013672 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13673 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13674 the corresponding match text.
13675
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013676 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13677 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13678 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13679 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13680 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013681
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013682 Example :
13683
13684 # this is a comment and is ignored
13685 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13686 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13687 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13688 | | | `---------- value
13689 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13690 | `---------------------------- key
13691 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13692
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013693mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013694 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13695 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013696 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013697 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013698 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013699 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13700 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13701 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13702 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013703 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013704 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013705
13706mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013707 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013708 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13709 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013710 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013711 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013712 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013713 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13714 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13715 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13716 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013717 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013718 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013719
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013720nbsrv
13721 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13722 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13723 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13724 map lookup.
13725
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013726neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013727 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13728 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13729 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13730 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013731
13732not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013733 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013734 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013735 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013736 absence of a flag).
13737
13738odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013739 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013740 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13741
13742or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013743 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013744 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013745 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13746 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013747 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013748 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13749 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13750 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13751 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013752 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013753 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013754
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013755protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13756 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13757 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13758 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13759 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13760 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13761 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13762 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13763 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13764 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13765 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13766 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13767
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013768regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013769 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13770 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13771 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13772 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13773 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13774 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13775 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13776 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13777 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13778 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013779 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13780 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13781 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13782 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013783
13784 Example :
13785
13786 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13787 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13788 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13789 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13790
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013791capture-req(<id>)
13792 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13793 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13794
13795 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013796 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13797 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013798
13799capture-res(<id>)
13800 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13801 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13802
13803 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013804 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13805 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013806
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013807sdbm([<avalanche>])
13808 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13809 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13810 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13811 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13812 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13813 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13814 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013815 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13816 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013817
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013818set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013819 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13820 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13821 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013822 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013823 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13824 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013825 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013826 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13827 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013828 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013829 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013830
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013831sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013832 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013833 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13834
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020013835sha2([<bits>])
13836 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
13837 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
13838
13839 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
13840 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
13841
13842 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
13843 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
13844
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020013845srv_queue
13846 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
13847 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
13848 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
13849 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
13850 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
13851
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013852strcmp(<var>)
13853 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13854 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13855 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13856 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13857 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13858 shorter).
13859
13860 Example :
13861
13862 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13863 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13864 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13865
13866
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013867sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013868 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13869 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013870 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013871 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13872 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013873 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013874 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13875 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013876 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013877 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13878 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013879 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013880 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013881
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013882table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13883 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13884 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13885 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13886 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13887 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13888 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13889
13890
13891table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13892 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13893 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13894 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13895 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13896 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13897 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13898
13899table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13900 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13901 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013902 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013903 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13904 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13905
13906table_conn_cur(<table>)
13907 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13908 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13909 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13910 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13911 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13912
13913table_conn_rate(<table>)
13914 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13915 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13916 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13917 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13918 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13919
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013920table_gpt0(<table>)
13921 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13922 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13923 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13924 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13925 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13926
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013927table_gpc0(<table>)
13928 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13929 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13930 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13931 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13932 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13933
13934table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13935 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13936 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13937 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13938 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13939 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13940 sample fetch keyword.
13941
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013942table_gpc1(<table>)
13943 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13944 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13945 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13946 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13947 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13948
13949table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13950 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13951 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13952 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13953 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13954 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13955 sample fetch keyword.
13956
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013957table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13958 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13959 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013960 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013961 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13962 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13963
13964table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13965 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13966 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13967 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13968 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13969 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13970 keyword.
13971
13972table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13973 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13974 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013975 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013976 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13977 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13978
13979table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13980 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13981 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13982 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13983 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13984 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13985 keyword.
13986
13987table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13988 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13989 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013990 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013991 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13992 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13993 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13994 keyword.
13995
13996table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13997 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13998 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013999 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014000 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14001 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14002 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14003 keyword.
14004
14005table_server_id(<table>)
14006 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14007 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14008 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14009 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14010 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14011 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14012
14013table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14014 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14015 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014016 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014017 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14018 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14019 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14020 keyword.
14021
14022table_sess_rate(<table>)
14023 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14024 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14025 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14026 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14027 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14028 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14029 keyword.
14030
14031table_trackers(<table>)
14032 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14033 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14034 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14035 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14036 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14037 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14038 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14039 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14040 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14041 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14042
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014043upper
14044 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14045 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14046 type. The result is of type string.
14047
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014048url_dec
14049 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14050 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14051
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014052ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014053 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014054 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14055 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14056 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014057 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14058 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14059 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14060 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014061 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014062 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14063 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014064
14065 Example:
14066 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14067 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14068
14069 message Point {
14070 int32 latitude = 1;
14071 int32 longitude = 2;
14072 }
14073
14074 message PPoint {
14075 Point point = 59;
14076 }
14077
14078 message Rectangle {
14079 // One corner of the rectangle.
14080 PPoint lo = 48;
14081 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14082 PPoint hi = 49;
14083 }
14084
14085 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14086 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14087 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14088
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014089 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14090 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014091 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014092 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14093
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014094 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014095
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014096 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014097
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014098 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014099 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14100 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14101
14102 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14103 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14104 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14105
14106 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14107 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14108 interpret the previous binary sample.
14109
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014110
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014111unset-var(<var name>)
14112 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14113 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14114 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14115 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14116 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14117 response),
14118 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14119 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14120 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14121 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14122
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014123utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14124 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14125 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14126 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14127 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14128 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14129 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14130
14131 Example :
14132
14133 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014134 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014135 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14136
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014137word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14138 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14139 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14140 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14141 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14142 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14143
14144 Example :
14145 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14146 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14147 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14148 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14149 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014150
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014151wt6([<avalanche>])
14152 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14153 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14154 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14155 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14156 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14157 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14158 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014159 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14160 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014161
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014162xor(<value>)
14163 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014164 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014165 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014166 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014167 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014168 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14169 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014170 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014171 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14172 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014173 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014174 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014175
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014176xxh32([<seed>])
14177 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14178 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14179 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14180 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14181 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14182 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14183 as cryptographically secure.
14184
14185xxh64([<seed>])
14186 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14187 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14188 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14189 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14190 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14191 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14192 as cryptographically secure.
14193
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014194
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200141957.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014196--------------------------------------------
14197
14198A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14199not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14200"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14201The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14202
14203always_false : boolean
14204 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14205 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14206
14207always_true : boolean
14208 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14209 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14210
14211avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014212 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014213 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14214 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14215 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14216 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14217 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14218 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14219 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14220 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14221 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14222 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14223 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14224 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14225 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014227be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014228 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14229 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14230 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14231 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014232 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14233
14234be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14235 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14236 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14237 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14238 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14239 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014240 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14241 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014242
14243 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14244 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14245 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014247be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14248 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14249 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14250 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014251 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014252 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14253 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014254
14255 Example :
14256 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14257 backend dynamic
14258 mode http
14259 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14260 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014261
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014262bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014263 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14264 of the string.
14265
14266bool(<bool>) : bool
14267 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14268 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014270connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14271 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014272 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014273 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14274 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014275
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014276 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014277 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014278 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14279
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014280 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14281 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014282
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014283 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014284 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014285 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014286 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014287 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014288 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014289 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014290
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014291 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14292 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014293 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014294 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014295
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014296cpu_calls : integer
14297 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14298 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14299 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14300 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14301 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14302 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14303
14304cpu_ns_avg : integer
14305 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14306 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14307 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14308 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14309 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14310 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14311 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14312 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14313 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14314 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14315 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14316
14317cpu_ns_tot : integer
14318 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14319 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14320 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14321 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14322 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14323 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14324 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14325 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14326 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14327 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14328 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14329 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14330 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14331
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014332date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014333 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014334
14335 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
14336 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
14337 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014338 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14339
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014340 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
14341 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
14342 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
14343 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
14344 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
14345
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014346 Example :
14347
14348 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14349 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014350
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014351 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
14352 # millisecond granularity
14353 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
14354
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014355date_us : integer
14356 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14357 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14358 from the same timeval structure.
14359
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014360distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14361 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14362 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14363 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14364 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14365 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14366 list of supported tokens.
14367
14368distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14369 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14370 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14371 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14372 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14373 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14374 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14375 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14376 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14377 supported tokens.
14378
14379 Example :
14380 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14381 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14382 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14383 # send large files to the big farm
14384 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14385
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014386env(<name>) : string
14387 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14388 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14389 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14390 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14391 certain way.
14392
14393 Examples :
14394 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14395 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14396
14397 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14398 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014400fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14401 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014402 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14403 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014404 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14405 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014406 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014407 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14408 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014409
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014410fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14411 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14412 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14413 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014415fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14416 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14417 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14418 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14419 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14420 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14421 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14422 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14423 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014424
14425 Example :
14426 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14427 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14428 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14429 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14430 frontend mail
14431 bind :25
14432 mode tcp
14433 maxconn 100
14434 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14435 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14436 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14437 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014438
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014439hostname : string
14440 Returns the system hostname.
14441
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014442int(<integer>) : signed integer
14443 Returns a signed integer.
14444
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014445ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14446 Returns an ipv4.
14447
14448ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14449 Returns an ipv6.
14450
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014451lat_ns_avg : integer
14452 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14453 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14454 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14455 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14456 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14457 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14458 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14459 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14460 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14461 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14462 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14463 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14464 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14465 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14466
14467lat_ns_tot : integer
14468 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14469 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14470 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14471 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14472 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14473 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14474 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14475 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14476 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14477 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14478 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14479 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14480 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14481 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14482 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14483 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14484 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14485 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14486 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14487
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014488meth(<method>) : method
14489 Returns a method.
14490
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014491nbproc : integer
14492 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14493 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14494 and debugging purposes.
14495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014496nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14497 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14498 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14499 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014500 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14501 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14502 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014503
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014504prio_class : integer
14505 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14506 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14507 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14508
14509prio_offset : integer
14510 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14511 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14512 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14513 set-priority-offset".
14514
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014515proc : integer
14516 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14517 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14518 debugging purposes.
14519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014520queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014521 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14522 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14523 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014524 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14525 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14526 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14527 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14528 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14529
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014530rand([<range>]) : integer
14531 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14532 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14533 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14534 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14535 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14536
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014537uuid([<version>]) : string
14538 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14539 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14540 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014542srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14543 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14544 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14545 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14546 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14547 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014548 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14549 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14550
14551srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14552 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14553 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14554 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14555 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14556 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14557 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14558 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14559
14560 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14561 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014562
14563srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14564 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14565 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14566 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014567 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014568 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14569 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14570 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14571
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014572srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14573 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14574 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14575 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14576 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14577 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14578 fetch methods.
14579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014580srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14581 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14582 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014583 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014584 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14585 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014586 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014587 overloading servers).
14588
14589 Example :
14590 # Redirect to a separate back
14591 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14592 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14593 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14594
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014595stopping : boolean
14596 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14597 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14598 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14599
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014600str(<string>) : string
14601 Returns a string.
14602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014603table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14604 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14605 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14606
14607table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14608 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14609 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14610 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14611
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014612thread : integer
14613 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14614 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14615 and debugging purposes.
14616
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014617var(<var-name>) : undefined
14618 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014619 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14620 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014621 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014622 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14623 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014624 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014625 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14626 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014627 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014628 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014629
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200146307.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014631----------------------------------
14632
14633The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14634closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14635methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14636sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14637TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014638the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14639counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014640"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14641used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14642can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14643Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14644table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14645tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14646currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014647
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014648bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014649 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14650 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14651 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014653be_id : integer
14654 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14655 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14656
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014657be_name : string
14658 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14659 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014661dst : ip
14662 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14663 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14664 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14665 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014666 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14667 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14668 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14669 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14670 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14671 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014672
14673dst_conn : integer
14674 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14675 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14676 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14677 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14678 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14679 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14680 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14681 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014682
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014683dst_is_local : boolean
14684 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14685 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14686 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14687 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014688 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014689 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14690 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14691 it only once per connection.
14692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014693dst_port : integer
14694 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14695 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14696 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14697 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14698 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14699 an HTTP header.
14700
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014701fc_http_major : integer
14702 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14703 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14704 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14705
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020014706fc_pp_authority : string
14707 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
14708 if any.
14709
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014710fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14711 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14712 header.
14713
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014714fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14715 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14716 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14717 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14718 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14719 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14720 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14721
14722fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14723 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14724 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14725 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14726 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14727 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14728 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14729
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014730fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014731 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14732 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14733 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14734 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14735
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014736fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014737 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14738 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14739 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14740 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14741
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014742fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014743 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14744 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14745 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14746 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14747
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014748fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014749 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14750 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14751 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14752 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14753
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014754fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014755 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14756 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14757 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14758 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14759
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020014760fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014761 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14762 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14763 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14764 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14765
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014766fe_defbe : string
14767 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14768 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014770fe_id : integer
14771 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014772 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014773 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14774
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014775fe_name : string
14776 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14777 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14778 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14779
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014780sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014781sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14782sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14783sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014784 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14785 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14786 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14787
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014788sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014789sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14790sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14791sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014792 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14793 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14794 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14795
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014796sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014797sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14798sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14799sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014800 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14801 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014802 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14803 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14804 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014805
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014806 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014807 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14808 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014809 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14810 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14811 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014812 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14813 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14814
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014815sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14816sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14817sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14818sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14819 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14820 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14821 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14822 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14823 when a first ACL was verified.
14824
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014825sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014826sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14827sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14828sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014829 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014830 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14831
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014832sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014833sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14834sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14835sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014836 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14837 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14838 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14839
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014840sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014841sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14842sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14843sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014844 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14845 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14846 See also src_conn_rate.
14847
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014848sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014849sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14850sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14851sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014852 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014853 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014854
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014855sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14856sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14857sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14858sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14859 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14860 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14861
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014862sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14863sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14864sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14865sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14866 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14867 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14868
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014869sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014870sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14871sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14872sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014873 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14874 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14875 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014876 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14877 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14878 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014879
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014880sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14881sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14882sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14883sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14884 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14885 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14886 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14887 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14888 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14889 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14890
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014891sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014892sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14893sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14894sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014895 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014896 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14897 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14898
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014899sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014900sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14901sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14902sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014903 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14904 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14905 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14906 src_http_err_rate.
14907
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014908sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014909sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14910sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14911sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014912 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014913 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14914 src_http_req_cnt.
14915
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014916sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014917sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14918sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14919sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014920 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14921 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14922 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14923 src_http_req_rate.
14924
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014925sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014926sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14927sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14928sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014929 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014930 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14931 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14932 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14933 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014934
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014935 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014936 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14937 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014938 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14939
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014940sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14941sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14942sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14943sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14944 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14945 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14946 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14947 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14948 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14949
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014950sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014951sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14952sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14953sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014954 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14955 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14956 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014957
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014958sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014959sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14960sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14961sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014962 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14963 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14964 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014965
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014966sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014967sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14968sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14969sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014970 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014971 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14972 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14973 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014974 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014975 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14976
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014977sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014978sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14979sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14980sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014981 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14982 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14983 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14984 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14985 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014986 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014987
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014988sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014989sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14990sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14991sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014992 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14993 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14994 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14995
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014996sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014997sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14998sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14999sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015000 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15001 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015002 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015003 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15004 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015005 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15006 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15007 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015009so_id : integer
15010 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15011 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15012 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015014src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015015 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015016 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15017 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15018 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015019 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15020 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15021 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015022 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15023 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15024 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15025 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15026 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15027 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15028 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015029
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015030 Example:
15031 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15032 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015034src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15035 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15036 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15037 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015038 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015040src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15041 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15042 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015043 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015044 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015046src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15047 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15048 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15049 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15050 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15051 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15052 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015053
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015054 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015055 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15056 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15057 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15058 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015059 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015060 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15061 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15062
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015063src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15064 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15065 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15066 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15067 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15068 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15069 was verified.
15070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015071src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015072 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015073 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015074 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015075 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015077src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015078 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015079 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15080 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015081 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015083src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15084 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15085 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15086 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015087 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015089src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015090 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015091 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015092 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015093 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015094
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015095src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15096 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15097 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15098 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15099 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15100
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015101src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15102 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15103 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15104 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15105 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015107src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015108 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015109 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015110 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15111 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015112 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15113 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15114 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015115
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015116src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15117 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15118 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15119 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15120 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15121 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15122 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15123 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015125src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015126 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015127 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015128 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015129 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015130 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015132src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15133 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15134 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15135 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15136 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015137 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015139src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015140 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015141 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15142 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015143 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015145src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15146 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15147 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15148 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015149 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015150 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015152src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15153 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15154 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15155 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015156 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015157 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15158 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015159
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015160 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015161 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015162 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015163 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015164
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015165src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15166 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15167 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15168 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15169 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15170 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15171 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15172
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015173src_is_local : boolean
15174 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15175 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15176 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15177 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015178 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015179 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15180 once per connection.
15181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015182src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015183 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15184 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15185 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15186 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15187 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015189src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015190 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15191 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15192 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15193 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15194 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015196src_port : integer
15197 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15198 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15199 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15200 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015202src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015203 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015204 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15205 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15206 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015207 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015209src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15210 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15211 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15212 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15213 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015214 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015216src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15217 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15218 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15219 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15220 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15221 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15222 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15223 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15224 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015225
15226 Example :
15227 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15228 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15229 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15230 listen ssh
15231 bind :22
15232 mode tcp
15233 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015234 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015235 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015236 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015238srv_id : integer
15239 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15240 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15241 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015242
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080015243srv_name : string
15244 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
15245 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15246 debugging.
15247
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200152487.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015249----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015251The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15252closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15253when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15254usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015255future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015256
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001525751d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15258 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15259 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15260 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15261 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15262 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15263
15264 Example :
15265 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15266 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15267 # the request.
15268 frontend http-in
15269 bind *:8081
15270 default_backend servers
15271 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15272 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15273
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015274ssl_bc : boolean
15275 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15276 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15277 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15278
15279ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15280 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15281 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15282
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015283ssl_bc_alpn : string
15284 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15285 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015286 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015287 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15288 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15289 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15290 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15291 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15292 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15293
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015294ssl_bc_cipher : string
15295 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15296 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15297
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015298ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15299 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15300 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15301 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15302
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015303ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15304 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15305 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15306 session or a TLS ticket.
15307
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015308ssl_bc_npn : string
15309 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15310 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015311 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015312 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15313 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15314 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15315 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15316 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15317
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015318ssl_bc_protocol : string
15319 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15320 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15321
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015322ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015323 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015324 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15325 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015326
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015327ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15328 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15329 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15330 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15331
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015332ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15333 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15334 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15335 if session was reused or not.
15336
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015337ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15338 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15339 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15340 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15341 BoringSSL.
15342
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015343ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15344 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15345 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015347ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15348 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15349 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15350 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15351 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15352 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015354ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15355 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15356 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15357 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15358 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015359
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015360ssl_c_der : binary
15361 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15362 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15363 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015365ssl_c_err : integer
15366 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15367 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15368 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15369 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15370 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015371
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015372ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015373 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15374 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15375 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15376 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15377 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15378 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15379 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15380 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015381 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15382 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15383 LDAP v3.
15384 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15385 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015387ssl_c_key_alg : string
15388 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15389 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15390 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015392ssl_c_notafter : string
15393 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15394 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15395 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015397ssl_c_notbefore : string
15398 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15399 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15400 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015401
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015402ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015403 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15404 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15405 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15406 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15407 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15408 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15409 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15410 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015411 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15412 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15413 LDAP v3.
15414 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15415 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015417ssl_c_serial : binary
15418 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15419 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15420 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015422ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15423 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15424 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15425 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015426 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15427 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15428
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015429 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015430 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015432ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15433 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15434 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15435 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015437ssl_c_used : boolean
15438 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15439 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015441ssl_c_verify : integer
15442 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15443 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15444 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15445 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015447ssl_c_version : integer
15448 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15449 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015450
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015451ssl_f_der : binary
15452 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15453 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15454 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15455
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015456ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015457 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15458 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15459 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15460 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015461 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015462 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15463 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15464 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015465 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15466 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15467 LDAP v3.
15468 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15469 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015471ssl_f_key_alg : string
15472 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15473 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15474 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015476ssl_f_notafter : string
15477 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15478 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15479 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015481ssl_f_notbefore : string
15482 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15483 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15484 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015485
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015486ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015487 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15488 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15489 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15490 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15491 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15492 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15493 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15494 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050015495 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
15496 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
15497 LDAP v3.
15498 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
15499 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015501ssl_f_serial : binary
15502 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15503 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15504 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015505
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015506ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15507 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15508 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15509 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015511ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15512 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15513 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15514 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015516ssl_f_version : integer
15517 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15518 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15519
15520ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015521 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15522 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15523 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015525 Example :
15526 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15527 listen http-https
15528 bind :80
15529 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15530 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15531
15532ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15533 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15534 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15535
15536ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015537 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015538 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15539 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15540 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15541 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15542 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15543 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15544 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15545 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015547ssl_fc_cipher : string
15548 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15549 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015550
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015551ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15552 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15553 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015554 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015555
15556ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15557 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15558 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015559 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015560
15561ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15562 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15563 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15564 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015565 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015566 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015567
15568ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15569 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15570 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015571 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015572
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015573ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15574 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15575 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15576 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015578ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015579 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15580 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015581 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15582 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15583 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15584 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015585
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015586ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15587 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15588 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15589 wait until the handshake happened.
15590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015591ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15592 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015593 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15594 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015595 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015596 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015597
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015598ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015599 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015600 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15601 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015603ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015604 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015605 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15606 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15607 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15608 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15609 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15610 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15611 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015613ssl_fc_protocol : string
15614 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15615 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015616
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015617ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015618 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015619 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15620 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015621
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015622ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15623 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15624 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15625 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015627ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15628 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15629 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15630 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15631 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015632
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015633ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15634 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15635 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15636 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15637 BoringSSL.
15638
15639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015640ssl_fc_sni : string
15641 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15642 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15643 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15644 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15645 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15646
15647 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15648 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15649 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015650 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015651 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015653 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015654 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15655 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015657ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15658 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15659 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015660
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015661
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156627.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015663------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015665Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15666sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15667only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15668For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15669be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15670can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15671sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15672for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15673content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015675payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015676 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015677 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15678 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015680payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15681 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015682 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015683 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015684
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015685req.hdrs : string
15686 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15687 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15688 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15689 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15690
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015691req.hdrs_bin : binary
15692 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15693 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15694 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15695 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15696 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15697 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15698
15699 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15700
15701 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15702 str: <int:length><bytes>
15703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015704req.len : integer
15705req_len : integer (deprecated)
15706 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15707 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15708 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15709 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15710 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15711 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15712 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15713 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015715req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15716 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015717 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15718 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15719 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15720 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015722 ACL alternatives :
15723 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015725req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15726 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15727 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15728 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15729 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015731 ACL alternatives :
15732 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015734 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015736req.proto_http : boolean
15737req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15738 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15739 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15740 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15741 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15742 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15743 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15744 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015746 Example:
15747 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15748 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15749 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015750 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015752req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15753rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15754 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15755 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15756 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15757 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15758 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15759 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15760 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015762 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15763 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15764 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15765 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15766 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15767 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015769 ACL derivatives :
15770 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015772 Example :
15773 listen tse-farm
15774 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15775 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15776 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15777 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15778 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15779 persist rdp-cookie
15780 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15781 # This is only useful makes sense if
15782 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15783 stick-table type string size 204800
15784 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15785 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15786 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015788 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15789 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015791req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15792rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15793 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15794 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15795 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15796 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015798 ACL derivatives :
15799 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015800
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015801req.ssl_alpn : string
15802 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15803 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15804 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15805 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15806 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15807 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015808 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015809
15810 Examples :
15811 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15812 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15813 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015814 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015815 default_backend bk_default
15816
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015817req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15818 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15819 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015820 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15821 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15822 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15823 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15824 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015826req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15827req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15828 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15829 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15830 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15831 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15832 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15833 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15834 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015836req.ssl_sni : string
15837req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15838 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15839 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15840 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15841 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15842 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15843 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15844 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15845 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15846 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15847 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15848 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15849 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015851 ACL derivatives :
15852 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015854 Examples :
15855 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15856 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15857 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15858 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15859 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015860
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015861req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15862 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15863 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15864 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15865 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15866 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15867 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15868 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15869 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15870 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015872req.ssl_ver : integer
15873req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15874 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15875 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15876 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15877 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15878 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15879 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15880 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015881 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015882 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015884 ACL derivatives :
15885 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015886
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015887res.len : integer
15888 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15889 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15890 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15891 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15892 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15893 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15894 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15895 content inspection.
15896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015897res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15898 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015899 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15900 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15901 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15902 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015904res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15905 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15906 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15907 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15908 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015910 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015911
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015912res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15913rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15914 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15915 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15916 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15917 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15918 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15919 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15920 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015922wait_end : boolean
15923 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15924 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015925 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015926 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15927 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015928 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015929 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15930 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015932 Examples :
15933 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15934 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15935 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015937 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15938 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15939 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15940 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15941 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15942 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15943 tcp-request content reject
15944
15945
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200159467.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015947--------------------------------------
15948
15949It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15950This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15951data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15952its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15953HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15954content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15955to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15956more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15957response are indexed.
15958
15959base : string
15960 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15961 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15962 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15963 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15964 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15965 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15966 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15967 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15968
15969 ACL derivatives :
15970 base : exact string match
15971 base_beg : prefix match
15972 base_dir : subdir match
15973 base_dom : domain match
15974 base_end : suffix match
15975 base_len : length match
15976 base_reg : regex match
15977 base_sub : substring match
15978
15979base32 : integer
15980 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15981 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15982 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015983 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15984 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15985 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015986
15987base32+src : binary
15988 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15989 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15990 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15991 per-URL counters.
15992
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015993capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15994 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15995 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15996 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15997
15998capture.req.method : string
15999 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16000 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16001 because it's allocated.
16002
16003capture.req.uri : string
16004 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16005 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16006 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16007 allocated.
16008
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016009capture.req.ver : string
16010 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16011 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16012 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16013
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016014capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16015 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16016 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16017 The first entry is an index of 0.
16018 See also: "capture response header"
16019
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016020capture.res.ver : string
16021 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16022 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16023 persistent flag.
16024
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016025req.body : binary
16026 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16027 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16028 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16029 the first chunk is analyzed.
16030
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016031req.body_param([<name>) : string
16032 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16033 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16034 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16035 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16036 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16037 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16038 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16039 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16040 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16041 given.
16042
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016043req.body_len : integer
16044 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16045 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16046 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16047 "option http-buffer-request".
16048
16049req.body_size : integer
16050 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16051 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16052 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16053 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16054 "option http-buffer-request".
16055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016056req.cook([<name>]) : string
16057cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16058 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16059 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16060 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16061 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16062 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16063 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16064 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16065 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16066
16067 ACL derivatives :
16068 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16069 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16070 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16071 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16072 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16073 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16074 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16075 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016077req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16078cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16079 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16080 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016082req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16083cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16084 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16085 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16086 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16087 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016089cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16090 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16091 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16092 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16093 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016094 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016095 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16096 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16097 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16098 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016100hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16101 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16102 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16103 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16104 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016105 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016107req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16108 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16109 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16110 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16111 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16112 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16113 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16114 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16115 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016117req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16118 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16119 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16120 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16121 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016123req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16124 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16125 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16126 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16127 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16128 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16129 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16130 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16131 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016132 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016133 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016134 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016136 ACL derivatives :
16137 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16138 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16139 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16140 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16141 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16142 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16143 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16144 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16145
16146req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16147hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16148 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16149 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16150 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16151 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16152 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16153 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16154 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16155 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16156 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16157
16158req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16159hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16160 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16161 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16162 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16163 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16164 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016165 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016166 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16167 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16168
16169req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16170hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16171 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16172 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16173 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16174 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16175 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16176 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16177 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16178
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016179
16180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016181http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16182 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16183 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16184 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16185 basic auth is supported.
16186
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016187http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16188 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16189 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16190 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16191 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016192 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16193 basic auth is supported.
16194
16195 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016196 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16197 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16198 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16199 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016200
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020016201http_auth_pass : string
16202 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
16203 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16204 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16205
16206http_auth_type : string
16207 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
16208 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
16209 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16210
16211http_auth_user : string
16212 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
16213 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
16214 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
16215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016216http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016217 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16218 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016219 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16220 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016222method : integer + string
16223 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16224 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16225 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16226 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16227 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16228 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16229 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016231 ACL derivatives :
16232 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016234 Example :
16235 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16236 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16237 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016239path : string
16240 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16241 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16242 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16243 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16244 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016245 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016246 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016248 ACL derivatives :
16249 path : exact string match
16250 path_beg : prefix match
16251 path_dir : subdir match
16252 path_dom : domain match
16253 path_end : suffix match
16254 path_len : length match
16255 path_reg : regex match
16256 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016257
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016258query : string
16259 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16260 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16261 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16262 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016263 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016264 which stops before the question mark.
16265
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016266req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16267 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16268 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16269 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16270 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016272req.ver : string
16273req_ver : string (deprecated)
16274 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16275 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16276 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016278 ACL derivatives :
16279 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016281res.comp : boolean
16282 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16283 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16284 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016286res.comp_algo : string
16287 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16288 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16289 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016291res.cook([<name>]) : string
16292scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16293 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16294 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16295 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016297 ACL derivatives :
16298 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016300res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16301scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16302 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16303 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16304 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016306res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16307scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16308 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16309 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16310 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016312res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16313 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16314 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16315 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16316 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16317 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16318 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16319 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16320 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16321 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016323res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16324 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16325 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16326 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16327 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16328 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016330res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16331shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16332 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16333 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16334 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16335 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16336 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16337 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16338 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16339 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016341 ACL derivatives :
16342 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16343 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16344 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16345 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16346 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16347 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16348 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16349 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16350
16351res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16352shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16353 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16354 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16355 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16356 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16357 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016359res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16360shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16361 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16362 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16363 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16364 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16365 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16366 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016367
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016368res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16369 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16370 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16371 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16372 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016374res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16375shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16376 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16377 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16378 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16379 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16380 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16381 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016383res.ver : string
16384resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16385 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16386 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016388 ACL derivatives :
16389 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016391set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16392 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16393 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016394 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016395 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016397 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16398 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016400status : integer
16401 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16402 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16403 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016404
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016405unique-id : string
16406 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16407 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16408 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16409 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16410 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16411 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016413url : string
16414 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16415 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16416 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16417 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16418 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16419 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16420 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016422 ACL derivatives :
16423 url : exact string match
16424 url_beg : prefix match
16425 url_dir : subdir match
16426 url_dom : domain match
16427 url_end : suffix match
16428 url_len : length match
16429 url_reg : regex match
16430 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016432url_ip : ip
16433 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16434 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16435 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16436 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16437 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16438 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16439 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016441url_port : integer
16442 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16443 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16444 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16445 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016446
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016447urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16448url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016449 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16450 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016451 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16452 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16453 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16454 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016455 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16456 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016457 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16458 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016460 ACL derivatives :
16461 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16462 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16463 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16464 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16465 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16466 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16467 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16468 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016469
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016471 Example :
16472 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16473 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16474 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16475 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016476
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016477urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016478 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16479 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16480 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016481
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016482url32 : integer
16483 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16484 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16485 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16486 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16487 is an unsigned integer.
16488
16489url32+src : binary
16490 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16491 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16492 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16493
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016494
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +0100164957.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
16496---------------------------------------
16497
16498This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
16499used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
16500purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
16501There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
16502or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
16503any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
16504for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
16505
16506internal.htx.data : integer
16507 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
16508 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16509
16510internal.htx.free : integer
16511 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
16512 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16513
16514internal.htx.free_data : integer
16515 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
16516 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16517
16518internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
16519 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
16520 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
16521 chosen depending on the sample direction.
16522
16523internal.htx.nbblks : integer
16524 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
16525 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16526
16527internal.htx.size : integer
16528 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
16529 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16530
16531internal.htx.used : integer
16532 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
16533 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16534 direction.
16535
16536internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
16537 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16538 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
16539 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
16540 of the special value :
16541 * head : The oldest inserted block
16542 * tail : The newest inserted block
16543 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16544
16545internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
16546 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16547 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
16548 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
16549 integer or one of the special value :
16550 * head : The oldest inserted block
16551 * tail : The newest inserted block
16552 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16553
16554internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
16555 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
16556 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
16557 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
16558 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16559
16560 * head : The oldest inserted block
16561 * tail : The newest inserted block
16562 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16563
16564internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
16565 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
16566 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
16567 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16568 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16569
16570 * head : The oldest inserted block
16571 * tail : The newest inserted block
16572 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16573
16574internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
16575 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
16576 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
16577 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16578 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16579
16580 * head : The oldest inserted block
16581 * tail : The newest inserted block
16582 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16583
16584internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
16585 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
16586 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
16587 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
16588 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
16589
16590 * head : The oldest inserted block
16591 * tail : The newest inserted block
16592 * fisrt : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
16593
16594internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
16595 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
16596 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
16597 it returns false.
16598
16599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200166007.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016601---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016602
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016603Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16604every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016605order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016606
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016607ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16608---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016609FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016610HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016611HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16612HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016613HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16614HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16615HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16616HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16617LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016618METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016619METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016620METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16621METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16622METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16623METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016624METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016625METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016626RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016627REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016628TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016629WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16630---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016631
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016632
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166338. Logging
16634----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016635
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016636One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16637provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16638very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16639provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16640state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016641to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016642headers.
16643
16644In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16645about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16646send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16647
16648 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16649 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16650 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16651 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16652 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016653 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016654 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016655
16656The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16657allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16658as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16659while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16660real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16661delay.
16662
16663
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166648.1. Log levels
16665---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016666
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016667TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016668source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016669HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16670in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16671track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16672syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16673about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016674
16675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166768.2. Log formats
16677----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016678
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016679HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016680and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16681slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16682options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016683
16684 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16685 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16686 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16687 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16688 extents.
16689
16690 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16691 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16692 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16693 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16694 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16695
16696 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16697 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16698 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16699 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16700 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16701
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016702 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16703 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16704 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16705 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16706
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016707 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16708
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016709Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16710specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16711field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16712servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16713always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16714identifier.
16715
16716Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16717 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16718 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16719 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16720 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16721
16722
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167238.2.1. Default log format
16724-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016725
16726This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16727as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16728format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16729
16730 Example :
16731 listen www
16732 mode http
16733 log global
16734 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16735
16736 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16737 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16738 (www/HTTP)
16739
16740 Field Format Extract from the example above
16741 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16742 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16743 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16744 4 'to' to
16745 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16746 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16747
16748Detailed fields description :
16749 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16750 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16751 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16752 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16753 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16754 and processed the connection.
16755 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16756
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016757In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16758"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16759connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16760
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016761It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16762will eventually disappear.
16763
16764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167658.2.2. TCP log format
16766---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016767
16768The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16769is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16770information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16771counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16772emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16773environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16774the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16775sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016776specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16777not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16778fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16779marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016780
16781 Example :
16782 frontend fnt
16783 mode tcp
16784 option tcplog
16785 log global
16786 default_backend bck
16787
16788 backend bck
16789 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16790
16791 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16792 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16793 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16794
16795 Field Format Extract from the example above
16796 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16797 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16798 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16799 4 frontend_name fnt
16800 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16801 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16802 7 bytes_read* 212
16803 8 termination_state --
16804 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16805 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16806
16807Detailed fields description :
16808 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016809 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16810 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16811 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016812 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016813 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016814 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016815
16816 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016817 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16818 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16819 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016820
16821 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16822 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16823 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016824 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16825 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16826 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16827 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016828
16829 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16830 and processed the connection.
16831
16832 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16833 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16834 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16835 applications.
16836
16837 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16838 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16839 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16840 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16841 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16842
16843 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16844 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16845 See "Timers" below for more details.
16846
16847 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16848 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16849 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16850 "Timers" below for more details.
16851
16852 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016853 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016854 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16855 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16856 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16857 details.
16858
16859 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16860 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16861 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16862 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16863 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16864
16865 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16866 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16867 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16868 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16869 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16870 for more details.
16871
16872 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016873 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016874 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16875 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16876 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016877 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016878
16879 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16880 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16881 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16882 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16883 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16884 caused by a denial of service attack.
16885
16886 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16887 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16888 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16889 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16890 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16891 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16892 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16893 denial of service attack.
16894
16895 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16896 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16897 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16898 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16899 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16900 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16901 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16902 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16903 be processed than on other servers.
16904
16905 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16906 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16907 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16908 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16909 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16910 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16911 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16912 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16913 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16914 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16915 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16916 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16917 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16918
16919 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16920 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16921 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16922 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16923 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16924 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016925 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016926 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16927
16928 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16929 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16930 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16931 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16932 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16933 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016934 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016935 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16936 occurs.
16937
16938
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169398.2.3. HTTP log format
16940----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016941
16942The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16943is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16944the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16945are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16946emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16947generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16948"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16949which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016950frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16951is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016952
16953Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16954slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16955with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16956
16957 Example :
16958 frontend http-in
16959 mode http
16960 option httplog
16961 log global
16962 default_backend bck
16963
16964 backend static
16965 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16966
16967 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16968 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16969 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016970 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016971
16972 Field Format Extract from the example above
16973 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16974 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016975 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016976 4 frontend_name http-in
16977 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016978 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016979 7 status_code 200
16980 8 bytes_read* 2750
16981 9 captured_request_cookie -
16982 10 captured_response_cookie -
16983 11 termination_state ----
16984 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16985 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16986 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16987 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16988 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016989
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016990Detailed fields description :
16991 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016992 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16993 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16994 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016995 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016996 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016997 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016998
16999 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017000 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17001 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17002 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017003
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017004 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17005 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017006
17007 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17008 and processed the connection.
17009
17010 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17011 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17012 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17013
17014 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17015 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17016 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17017 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17018 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17019 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17020
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017021 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17022 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17023 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017024 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017025 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17026 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017027 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17028 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017029
17030 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17031 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017032 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017033
17034 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17035 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017036 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17037 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017038
17039 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17040 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17041 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17042 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17043 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017044 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17045 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017046
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017047 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17048 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17049 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17050 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17051 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17052 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17053 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017054 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017055
17056 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17057 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17058 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17059
17060 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17061 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017062 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017063 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17064 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17065 overflowing.
17066
17067 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17068 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17069 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17070 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17071 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17072 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17073 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17074 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17075
17076 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17077 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17078 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17079 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17080 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17081 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17082 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17083 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17084
17085 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17086 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17087 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17088 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17089 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17090 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17091 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17092
17093 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017094 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017095 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17096 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17097 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017098 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017099 system.
17100
17101 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17102 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17103 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17104 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17105 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17106 caused by a denial of service attack.
17107
17108 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17109 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17110 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17111 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17112 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17113 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17114 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17115 denial of service attack.
17116
17117 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17118 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17119 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17120 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17121 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17122 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17123 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17124 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17125 processed than on other servers.
17126
17127 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17128 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17129 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17130 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17131 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17132 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17133 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17134 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17135 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17136 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17137 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17138 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17139 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17140
17141 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17142 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17143 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17144 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17145 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17146 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017147 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017148 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17149
17150 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17151 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17152 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17153 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17154 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17155 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017156 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017157 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17158 occurs.
17159
17160 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17161 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17162 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17163 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17164 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17165 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17166 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17167 cookies" below for more details.
17168
17169 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17170 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17171 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17172 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17173 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17174 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17175 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17176 and cookies" below for more details.
17177
17178 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17179 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17180 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17181 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17182 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17183 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17184 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17185 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17186
17187
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200171888.2.4. Custom log format
17189------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017190
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017191The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017192mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017193
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017194HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017195Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17196separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17197prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17198
17199Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17200variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017201("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017202
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017203If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017204as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017205less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17206the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17207
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017208Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017209In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017210in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017211
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017212Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17213'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17214https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17215such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17216
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017217Flags are :
17218 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017219 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017220 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17221 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017222
17223 Example:
17224
17225 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17226 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17227
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017228 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17229
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017230At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17231
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017232 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17233 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017234
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017235the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017236
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017237 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17238 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17239 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017240
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017241and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17242
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017243 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17244 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017245
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017246Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17247
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017248 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017249 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017250 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17251 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17252 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017253 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17254 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17255 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017256 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017257 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17258 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017259 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017260 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17261 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017262 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017263 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017264 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017265 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017266 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017267 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017268 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017269 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17270 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17271 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17272 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17273 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017274 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017275 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17276 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017277 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017278 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17279 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017280 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17281 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17282 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017283 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017284 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17285 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017286 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017287 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17288 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17289 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017290 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017291 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017292 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17293 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17294 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17295 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017296 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017297 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017298 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017299 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017300 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017301 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017302 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17303 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17304 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017305 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017306 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17307 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017308 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017309 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17310 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017311 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017312 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017313 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017314 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017315
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017316 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017317
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017318
173198.2.5. Error log format
17320-----------------------
17321
17322When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17323protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17324By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17325"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017326will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017327logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17328
17329The format looks like this :
17330
17331 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17332 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17333 Connection error during SSL handshake
17334
17335 Field Format Extract from the example above
17336 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17337 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17338 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17339 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17340 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17341
17342These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17343failures.
17344
17345
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173468.3. Advanced logging options
17347-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017348
17349Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17350just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17351options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17352for more information about their usage.
17353
17354
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173558.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17356------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017357
17358It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17359haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17360commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17361monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17362ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17363
17364 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17365 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17366 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17367 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17368
17369 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17370 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17371 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017372 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017373 such as other load-balancers.
17374
17375 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17376 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17377 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17378
17379
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173808.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17381----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017382
17383The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17384what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17385or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017386"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017387just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17388log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17389after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17390is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17391with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17392with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17393
17394
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173958.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17396------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017397
17398Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17399for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17400"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17401retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17402raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17403a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17404file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17405you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17406"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17407
17408
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174098.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17410--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017411
17412Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17413multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17414them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17415"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17416logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17417error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17418and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17419too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17420useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17421alternative.
17422
17423
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174248.4. Timing events
17425------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017426
17427Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17428reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17429the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17430frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017431mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17432addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17433
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017434Timings events in HTTP mode:
17435
17436 first request 2nd request
17437 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17438 t tr t tr ...
17439 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17440 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17441 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17442 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17443 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17444
17445Timings events in TCP mode:
17446
17447 TCP session
17448 |<----------------->|
17449 t t
17450 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17451 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17452 |<------ Tt ------->|
17453
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017454 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017455 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017456 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17457 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17458 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017459 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017460 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17461 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17462 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17463 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017464
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017465 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17466 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17467 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017468 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17469 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17470 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17471 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17472 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17473 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017474
17475 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17476 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17477 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17478 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17479 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17480 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17481 request typed by hand during a test.
17482
17483 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17484 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017485 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017486 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17487 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17488 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17489 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017490
17491 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17492 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17493 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17494 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17495 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17496
17497 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17498 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17499 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17500 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17501 connection never established.
17502
17503 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17504 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17505 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17506 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17507 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17508 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17509 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17510 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17511 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17512 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17513 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17514
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017515 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17516 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17517 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17518 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17519 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17520 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17521
17522 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17523
17524 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17525 "Ta" can never be negative.
17526
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017527 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17528 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017529 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17530 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017531 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017532
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017533 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017534
17535 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017536 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17537 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017538
17539These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17540protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17541that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017542due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17543"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17544that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017545
17546Most common cases :
17547
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017548 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17549 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17550 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17551 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17552 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17553 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17554 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17555 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17556 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17557 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17558 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017559 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017560
17561 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17562 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17563 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17564 of ms on remote networks.
17565
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017566 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17567 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17568 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017569
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017570 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17571 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17572 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17573 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17574 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17575 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17576 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17577 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17578 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017579
17580Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17581
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017582 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017583 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017584 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017585
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017586 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017587 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17588 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17589
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017590 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017591 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17592 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17593 flags.
17594
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017595 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17596 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017597 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17598 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17599 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17600 the client connection was maintained open.
17601
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017602 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017603 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017604 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017605 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17606
17607
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176088.5. Session state at disconnection
17609-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017610
17611TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17612"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
176132-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17614each of which has a special meaning :
17615
17616 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17617 session to terminate :
17618
17619 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17620
17621 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17622 server explicitly refused it.
17623
17624 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17625 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17626 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17627 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017628 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017629
17630 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17631 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017632
17633 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17634 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17635 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17636 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17637 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17638
17639 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17640 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17641 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17642 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17643 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17644
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017645 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17646 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17647
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017648 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17649 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17650 backup connections when going up.
17651
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017652 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17653
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017654 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17655 send or receive data.
17656
17657 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17658 send or receive data.
17659
17660 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17661 with nothing left in the buffers.
17662
17663 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17664
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017665 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017666 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17667
17668 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17669 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17670 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17671 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17672 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17673
17674 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17675 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17676
17677 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17678 server (HTTP only).
17679
17680 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17681
17682 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17683 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17684 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17685
17686 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17687 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17688 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17689
17690 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17691
17692 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17693 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17694
17695 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17696 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17697 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17698
17699 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17700 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017701 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17702 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017703
17704 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17705 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17706 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17707 another server.
17708
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017709 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017710 server.
17711
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017712 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17713 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17714 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17715 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17716
17717 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17718 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17719 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17720 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17721
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017722 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17723 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17724 "use-server" rule).
17725
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017726 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17727
17728 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17729 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17730
17731 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17732
17733 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17734 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17735 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17736
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017737 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17738 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017739 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017740 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17741 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17742
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017743 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17744
17745 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17746 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17747
17748 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17749
17750 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17751
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017752The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17753was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017754helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17755starvation, attacks, etc...
17756
17757The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17758alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17759easier finding and understanding.
17760
17761 Flags Reason
17762
17763 -- Normal termination.
17764
17765 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17766 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17767 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17768 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17769
17770 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17771 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17772 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17773 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17774 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17775 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017776
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017777 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17778 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017779 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017780
17781 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17782 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17783 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17784
17785 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17786 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17787 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17788 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17789 the server takes too long to respond.
17790
17791 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17792 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17793 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17794 long a time to respond.
17795
17796 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17797 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17798 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17799 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017800 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17801 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017802
17803 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17804 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17805 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17806 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17807 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017808 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017809 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17810 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17811 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17812 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17813 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17814 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17815 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17816 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017817 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017818 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17819 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17820 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017821
17822 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17823 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017824 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17825 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17826 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17827 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017828
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017829 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17830 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17831
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017832 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017833 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17834 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017835 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017836 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17837 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17838
17839 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17840 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17841 503 or 504 here.
17842
17843 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17844 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17845 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17846 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17847 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17848
17849 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17850 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017851 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017852 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17853 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17854
17855 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17856 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17857 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17858 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17859 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17860 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17861 between haproxy and the server.
17862
17863 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17864 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17865 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17866 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17867 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17868 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17869 solution is to fix the application.
17870
17871 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17872 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17873 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17874 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17875 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17876 external attacks.
17877
17878 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17879 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017880 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017881 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17882 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17883
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017884 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17885 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17886 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017887 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017888 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017889
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017890 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17891 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17892 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17893 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017894 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17895 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17896 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17897 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17898 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017899
17900 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17901 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17902 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17903 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17904
17905 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17906 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17907 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17908 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17909
17910 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17911 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17912 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17913 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17914
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017915The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17916persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17917important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17918re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17919
17920 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17921
17922 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17923 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17924 set on a GET request.
17925
17926 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17927 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017928 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017929 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17930
17931 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17932 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17933 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17934
17935 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17936 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17937 already got a cookie.
17938
17939 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17940 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17941 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17942 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17943 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17944
17945 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17946 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17947 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17948
17949 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17950 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17951 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17952
17953 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17954 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17955
17956 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17957 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17958 then advertised in the response.
17959
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017960
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179618.6. Non-printable characters
17962-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017963
17964In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17965consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17966converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17967prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17968being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17969escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17970is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17971'}' when logging headers.
17972
17973Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17974issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17975containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17976
17977Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17978the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17979performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17980
17981
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179828.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17983---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017984
17985Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17986achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017987section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017988cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17989the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17990the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017991locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017992not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17993user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17994a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17995wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17996
17997 Examples :
17998 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17999 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18000
18001 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18002 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18003
18004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180058.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18006---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018007
18008Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18009proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18010the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18011server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18012
18013Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18014response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018015section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018016
18017It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018018time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18019appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018020are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18021and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18022follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18023request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18024in the logs.
18025
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018026As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18027frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18028an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18029
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018030 Example :
18031 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18032 listen proxy-out
18033 mode http
18034 option httplog
18035 option logasap
18036 log global
18037 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18038
18039 # log the name of the virtual server
18040 capture request header Host len 20
18041
18042 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18043 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18044
18045 # log the beginning of the referrer
18046 capture request header Referer len 20
18047
18048 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18049 capture response header Server len 20
18050
18051 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18052 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18053
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018054 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018055 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18056
18057 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18058 capture response header Via len 20
18059
18060 # log the URL location during a redirection
18061 capture response header Location len 20
18062
18063 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18064 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18065 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18066 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18067 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18068
18069 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18070 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18071 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18072 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018073 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018074
18075 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18076 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18077 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18078 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18079 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018080 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018081
18082
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180838.9. Examples of logs
18084---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018085
18086These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18087them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18088reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18089
18090 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18091 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18092 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18093
18094 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18095 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18096
18097 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18098 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18099 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18100
18101 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18102 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18103
18104 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18105 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18106 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18107
18108 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018109 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018110 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18111 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18112
18113 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18114 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18115 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18116
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020018117 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
18118 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
18119 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
18120 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
18121 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
18122 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018123
18124 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018125 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018126
18127 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18128 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18129 Nothing was sent to any server.
18130
18131 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18132 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18133
18134 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18135 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018136 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018137 send a 408 return code to the client.
18138
18139 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18140 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18141
18142 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18143 5 seconds ("c----").
18144
18145 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18146 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018147 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018148
18149 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018150 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018151 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18152 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18153 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18154 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18155 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018156
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018157
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200181589. Supported filters
18159--------------------
18160
18161Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18162accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18163unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18164
18165See also : "filter"
18166
181679.1. Trace
18168----------
18169
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018170filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018171
18172 Arguments:
18173 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18174 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18175
18176 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18177 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18178 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18179 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18180
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018181 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018182 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18183 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18184 amount of the parsed data.
18185
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018186 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018187
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018188This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18189callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18190information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18191filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18192
18193Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18194tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18195a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18196
18197
181989.2. HTTP compression
18199---------------------
18200
18201filter compression
18202
18203The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18204keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018205when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
18206fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
18207done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
18208explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
18209filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
18210listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18211order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018212
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018213See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
18214 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018215
18216
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200182179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18218--------------------------------------------
18219
18220filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18221
18222 Arguments :
18223
18224 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18225 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18226 parsed.
18227
18228 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18229 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18230 part must be placed in its own scope.
18231
18232The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18233external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018234streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018235exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18236also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18237
18238SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18239the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18240
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018241For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018242"doc/SPOE.txt".
18243
18244Important note:
18245 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18246 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18247
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100182489.4. Cache
18249----------
18250
18251filter cache <name>
18252
18253 Arguments :
18254
18255 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18256
18257The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18258"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018259cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018260other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
18261case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
18262is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18263filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018264listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18265order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018266
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018267See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
18268 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
18269
18270
182719.5. Fcgi-app
18272-------------
18273
18274filter fcg-app <name>
18275
18276 Arguments :
18277
18278 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
18279
18280The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
18281request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
18282reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
18283used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
18284implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
18285used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
18286fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
18287used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18288order.
18289
18290See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
18291 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
18292
18293
1829410. FastCGI applications
18295-------------------------
18296
18297HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
18298feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
18299the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
18300FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
18301servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
18302FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
18303backend.
18304
18305HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
18306application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
18307connection.
18308
1830910.1. Setup
18310-----------
18311
1831210.1.1. Fcgi-app section
18313--------------------------
18314
18315fcgi-app <name>
18316 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
18317 document root must be defined.
18318
18319acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
18320 Declare or complete an access list.
18321
18322 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
18323 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
18324 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
18325 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
18326 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
18327
18328docroot <path>
18329 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
18330 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
18331 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
18332
18333index <script-name>
18334 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
18335 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
18336 is an optional setting.
18337
18338 Example :
18339 index index.php
18340
18341log-stderr global
18342log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
18343 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
18344 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
18345
18346 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
18347 default STDERR messages are ignored.
18348
18349pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18350 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
18351 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
18352 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18353
18354 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
18355 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
18356 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
18357 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
18358
18359 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
18360 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
18361
18362path-info <regex>
18363 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info
18364 from the URI. Thus, <regex> should have two captures: the first one to
18365 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. It is an
18366 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
18367 URI. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not filled.
18368
18369 Example :
18370 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18371
18372option get-values
18373no option get-values
18374 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
18375
18376 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
18377 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
18378
18379 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
18380 application will accept.
18381
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020018382 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
18383 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020018384
18385 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
18386 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
18387 option is disabled.
18388
18389 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
18390 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
18391 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
18392 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
18393 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
18394 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
18395
18396option keep-conn
18397no option keep-conn
18398 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
18399 sending a response.
18400
18401 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
18402 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
18403
18404option max-reqs <reqs>
18405 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
18406 accept.
18407
18408 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
18409 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
18410 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
18411 to 1.
18412
18413option mpxs-conns
18414no option mpxs-conns
18415 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
18416
18417 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
18418 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
18419
18420set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
18421 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
18422 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
18423 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
18424 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
18425
18426 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
18427 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
18428 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
18429
18430 Example :
18431 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
18432 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
18433
18434 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
18435
18436
1843710.1.2. Proxy section
18438---------------------
18439
18440use-fcgi-app <name>
18441 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
18442
18443 Arguments :
18444 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
18445
18446 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
18447 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
18448 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
18449 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
18450 application may be defined at a time per backend.
18451
18452 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
18453 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
18454 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
18455 application are evaluated.
18456
18457
1845810.1.3. Example
18459---------------
18460
18461 frontend front-http
18462 mode http
18463 bind *:80
18464 bind *:
18465
18466 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
18467 default_backend back-static
18468
18469 backend back-static
18470 mode http
18471 server www A.B.C.D:80
18472
18473 backend back-dynamic
18474 mode http
18475 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
18476 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
18477
18478 fcgi-app php-fpm
18479 log-stderr global
18480 option keep-conn
18481
18482 docroot /var/www/my-app
18483 index index.php
18484 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
18485
18486
1848710.2. Default parameters
18488------------------------
18489
18490A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
18491the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
18492scipt. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
18493applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
18494
18495 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18496 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
18497 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
18498 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
18499 | | |
18500 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18501 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
18502 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
18503 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
18504 | | application. |
18505 | | |
18506 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18507 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
18508 | | the request. It may not be set. |
18509 | | |
18510 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18511 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
18512 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
18513 | | the application's configuration. |
18514 | | |
18515 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18516 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
18517 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
18518 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
18519 | | |
18520 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18521 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
18522 | | following the part that identifies the script |
18523 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
18524 | | be defined. |
18525 | | |
18526 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18527 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
18528 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
18529 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
18530 | | is not set too. |
18531 | | |
18532 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18533 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
18534 | | set. |
18535 | | |
18536 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18537 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
18538 | | the request. |
18539 | | |
18540 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18541 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
18542 | | client as part of user authentication. |
18543 | | |
18544 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18545 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
18546 | | script to process the request. |
18547 | | |
18548 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18549 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
18550 | | |
18551 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18552 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
18553 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
18554 | | |
18555 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18556 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
18557 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
18558 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
18559 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
18560 | | |
18561 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18562 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
18563 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
18564 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
18565 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
18566 | | side. |
18567 | | |
18568 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18569 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
18570 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
18571 | | connected to. |
18572 | | |
18573 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18574 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
18575 | | |
18576 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18577 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
18578 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
18579 | | |
18580 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
18581
18582
1858310.3. Limitations
18584------------------
18585
18586The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
18587way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
18588during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
18589establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
18590application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
18591or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
18592message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
18593these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
18594and HTTP servers under the same backend.
18595
18596Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
18597request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
18598requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
18599
18600About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
18601into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
18602fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
18603"http-request" ones.
18604
18605Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
18606FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
18607processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
18608must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
18609here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018610
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018611/*
18612 * Local variables:
18613 * fill-column: 79
18614 * End:
18615 */